blob: fa12a16f4cba87a7ea91b9d9dd1781adfd79e98a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauca3551f2019-06-11 19:28:00 +02007 2019/06/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200480A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
481which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200483
4842.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200485----------------
486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100487Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100488values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
489otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
490numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
491for every keyword. Supported units are :
492
493 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
494 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
495 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
496 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
497 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
498 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
499
500
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005012.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200502-------------
503
504 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
505 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
506 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
507 global
508 daemon
509 maxconn 256
510
511 defaults
512 mode http
513 timeout connect 5000ms
514 timeout client 50000ms
515 timeout server 50000ms
516
517 frontend http-in
518 bind *:80
519 default_backend servers
520
521 backend servers
522 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
523
524
525 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
526 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
527 global
528 daemon
529 maxconn 256
530
531 defaults
532 mode http
533 timeout connect 5000ms
534 timeout client 50000ms
535 timeout server 50000ms
536
537 listen http-in
538 bind *:80
539 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
540
541
542Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
543
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100544 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200545
546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005473. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548--------------------
549
550Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
551are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
552of them have command-line equivalents.
553
554The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
555
556 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200557 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200559 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200560 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200562 - description
563 - deviceatlas-json-file
564 - deviceatlas-log-level
565 - deviceatlas-separator
566 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900567 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568 - gid
569 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100570 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200572 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100573 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200574 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200575 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200577 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100580 - presetenv
581 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - uid
583 - ulimit-n
584 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200585 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100586 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200587 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-bind-options
591 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200592 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - ssl-default-server-options
594 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100595 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100596 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100597 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100598 - 51degrees-data-file
599 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200600 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200601 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200602 - wurfl-data-file
603 - wurfl-information-list
604 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200605 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200608 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200610 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100611 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100612 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100613 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200614 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200615 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200616 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200617 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - noepoll
619 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000620 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100622 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300623 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000624 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100625 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200626 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200627 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200628 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000629 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000630 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200631 - tune.buffers.limit
632 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200633 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200634 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100635 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200636 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200637 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200638 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100639 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200640 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200641 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100642 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100644 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100645 - tune.lua.session-timeout
646 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200647 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100648 - tune.maxaccept
649 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200650 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200651 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200652 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100653 - tune.rcvbuf.client
654 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100655 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200656 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100657 - tune.sndbuf.client
658 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100659 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200661 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100662 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200663 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200664 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100665 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100667 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200668 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
669 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
670 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100671 - tune.zlib.memlevel
672 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 * Debugging
675 - debug
676 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677
678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680------------------------------------
681
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200682ca-base <dir>
683 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200684 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
685 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200687chroot <jail dir>
688 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
689 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
690 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
691 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
692 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100693 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100694
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100695cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
696 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
697 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
698 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
699 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
700 set. These sets have the format
701
702 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
703
704 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100705 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
707 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
709 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100711 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100713 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100714 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
715 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
716 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
717 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100718
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100719 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
720 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
721 on the machine's word size.
722
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100723 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
725 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
726 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
727 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
728 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
729 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100730
731 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
735 # first 4 CPUs
736
737 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
738 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
739 # word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100743 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
744 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
745 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
746
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
748 # and so on.
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
750 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
751 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
752
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100754 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
755 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
756 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
757
758 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
760 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
761
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
763 # and a thread range.
764 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
765 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
766 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
767
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200768crt-base <dir>
769 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
770 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
771 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
772
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773daemon
774 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
775 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100776 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
777 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779deviceatlas-json-file <path>
780 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782
783deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100784 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200785 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
786
787deviceatlas-separator <char>
788 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
789 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
790
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100791deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200792 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
793 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
794 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100795
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900796external-check
797 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
798 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
799 See "option external-check".
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801gid <number>
802 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
803 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
804 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100805 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
806 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100808
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100809hard-stop-after <time>
810 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
811
812 Arguments :
813 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
814 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
815 SIGUSR1 signal.
816
817 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
818 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
819 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
820
821 Example:
822 global
823 hard-stop-after 30s
824
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825group <group name>
826 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
827 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100828
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200829log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
830 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100831 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100832 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100833 configured with "log global".
834
835 <address> can be one of:
836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100837 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
839 port).
840
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100841 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
842 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
843 port).
844
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100845 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
847 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100850 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
851 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
852 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
853 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
854 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
855 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
856 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
857 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
858 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
859 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
860 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
861 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
862 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
863 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100864 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
865 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866
867 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
868 "fd@2", see above.
869
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200870 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
871 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100872
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200873 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
874 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
875 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
876 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
877 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
878 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
879 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
880 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
881 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
882 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100883 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
884 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200885
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200886 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
887 one of the following :
888
889 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
891
892 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
893 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
894
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100895 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
896 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
897 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
898 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
899 logger consumes.
900
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100901 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
902 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
903 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
904 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
905
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200906 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
907 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
908 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
909 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
910 set with <sample_size> parameter.
911
912 <sample_size>
913 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
914 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
915 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
916 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
917 (see also <ranges> parameter).
918
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100919 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100921 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
922 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
923 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
924
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100925 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
926 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
927 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
928 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200929
930 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200931 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
932 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
933 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
934 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
935 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
936 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200938 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200939
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100940log-send-hostname [<string>]
941 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
942 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
943 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
944 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
945 the logs.
946
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000947log-tag <string>
948 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
949 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
950 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100951 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100953lua-load <file>
954 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
955 used multiple times.
956
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100957master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200958 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
959 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
960 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100961 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200962 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
963 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100964 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
965 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
966 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
967 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
968 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200969
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100970 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200971
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200972mworker-max-reloads <number>
973 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
974 survive to a reload. If the worker did not left after a reload, once its
975 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
976 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
977 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
978
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200979nbproc <number>
980 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
981 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
982 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100983 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
984 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100985 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
986 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200988nbthread <number>
989 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100990 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
991 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
992 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
993 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
994 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100995 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
996 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
997 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
998 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
999 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1000 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1001 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001004 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1006 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1007
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008presetenv <name> <value>
1009 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1010 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1011 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1012 and "unsetenv".
1013
1014resetenv [<name> ...]
1015 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1016 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1017 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1018 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1019 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1020 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1021 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1022 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1023
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001024stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001025 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1026 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1027 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1028 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1029 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1030 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001031 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001032 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1033 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1034 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1035 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001036
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001037server-state-base <directory>
1038 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001039 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1040 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001041
1042server-state-file <file>
1043 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1044 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1045 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1046 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1047 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1048 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1049 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1050 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001051 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1052 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001054setenv <name> <value>
1055 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1056 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1057 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1058 and "unsetenv".
1059
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001060set-dumpable
1061 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1062 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1063 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1064 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1065 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1066 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1067 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1068 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1069 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1070 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1071 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1072 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1073 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1074 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1075 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1076 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1077 expected when dying.
1078
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001079ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1081 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001082 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001083 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001084 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1085 information and recommendations see e.g.
1086 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1087 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1088 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1089 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001090
1091ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1093 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1094 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1095 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1096 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001097 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1098 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1099 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001100 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001101
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001102ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1104 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1105 keyword to see available options.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001109 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001110
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001111ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1113 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001114 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001116 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1117 information and recommendations see e.g.
1118 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1119 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1120 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1121 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1122 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001123
1124ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1126 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1127 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1128 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1129 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001130 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1131 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1132 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1133 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001134
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001135ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1137 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1138 keyword to see available options.
1139
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001140ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1142 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1143 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001144 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001145 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001146 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1147 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1148 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1149 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001150 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1151 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1152 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1153
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001154ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1155 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1156 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1157 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1158
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001159stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1160 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1161 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1162 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001163 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001164 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001165
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001166 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1167 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1168 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001169
1170stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1171 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1172 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001173 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001174
1175stats maxconn <connections>
1176 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1177 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179uid <number>
1180 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1181 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1182 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1183 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1184
1185ulimit-n <number>
1186 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1187 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1188 option.
1189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001190unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1191 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1192
1193 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1194 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1195 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1196 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1197 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1198 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1199 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1200 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1201 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1202 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1203
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001204unsetenv [<name> ...]
1205 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1206 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1207 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1208 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1209 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1210 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1211 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1212
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001213user <user name>
1214 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1215 See also "uid" and "group".
1216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001217node <name>
1218 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1219
1220 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1221 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1222 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1223 traffic.
1224
1225description <text>
1226 Add a text that describes the instance.
1227
1228 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1229 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1230 "<" and ">" characters.
1231
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100123251degrees-data-file <file path>
1233 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001234 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001236 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001237 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1238
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000123951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001240 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1241 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1242 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1243
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001244 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1246
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200124751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001248 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1249 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1250
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001251 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1253
125451degrees-cache-size <number>
1255 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1256 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1257 By default, this cache is disabled.
1258
1259 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001260 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1261
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001262wurfl-data-file <file path>
1263 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1264 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1265
1266 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1267 with USE_WURFL=1.
1268
1269wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1270 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1271 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1272 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1273
1274 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1275
1276 Valid WURFL properties are:
1277 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1278
1279 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1280 device.
1281
1282 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1283 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1284
1285 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1286 particular web request.
1287
1288 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1289 used Libwurfl API version.
1290
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001291 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1292 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1293
1294 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1295 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1296
1297 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1298
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
1302wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1303 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1304 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1305
1306 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1307 with USE_WURFL=1.
1308
1309wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1310 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1311 thus before the chroot.
1312
1313 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1314 with USE_WURFL=1.
1315
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001316wurfl-cache-size <size>
1317 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1318 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001319 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001320 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001326-----------------------
1327
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001328busy-polling
1329 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1330 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1331 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1332 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1333 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1334 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1335 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1336 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1337 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1338 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1339 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1340 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1341 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1342 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1343 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1344 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1345 "poll" pollers.
1346
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001347max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1348 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1349 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1350 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1351 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1352 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1353 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1354 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1355 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1356
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001357maxconn <number>
1358 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1359 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1360 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001361 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1362 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1363 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1364 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001365 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1366 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1367 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1368 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1369 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1370 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001371
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001372maxconnrate <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1374 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1375 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1376 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1377 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1378 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1379 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1380 fairness.
1381
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001382maxcomprate <number>
1383 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001384 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001385 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1386 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1387 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001388 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001389 default value.
1390
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001391maxcompcpuusage <number>
1392 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1393 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1394 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1395 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1396 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1397 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1398 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1399 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1400
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001401maxpipes <number>
1402 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1403 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1404 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1405 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1406 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1407 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1408
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001409maxsessrate <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1411 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1412 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1413 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1414 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1415 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1416 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1417 fairness.
1418
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001419maxsslconn <number>
1420 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1421 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1422 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1423 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1424 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1425 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1426 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001427 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1428 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1429 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1430 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1431 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1432 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1433 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001434
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001435maxsslrate <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1437 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1438 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1439 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1440 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1441 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1442 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1443 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1444 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1445 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1446
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001447maxzlibmem <number>
1448 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1449 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1450 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001451 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1452 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1453 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455noepoll
1456 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1457 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001458 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001459
1460nokqueue
1461 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1462 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1463 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1464
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001465noevports
1466 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1467 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1468 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1469 also "nopoll".
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471nopoll
1472 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1473 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001475 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1476 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001477
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001478nosplice
1479 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001480 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001481 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001482 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001483 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1484 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1485 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1486 "option splice-response".
1487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001488nogetaddrinfo
1489 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1490 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1491
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001492noreuseport
1493 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1494 command line argument "-dR".
1495
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001496profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1497 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1498 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1499 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1500 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1501 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1502 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1503 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1504 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1505 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1506
1507 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1508 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1509 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1510 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1511 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001512 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1513 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1514 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1515 CLI.
1516
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001517spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001518 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1519 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1520 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1521 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1522 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1523 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001526 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001527 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001528 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1529 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1530 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1531 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1532 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001533 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1534 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001535 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1536 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1537 openssl configuration file uses:
1538 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1539
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001540ssl-mode-async
1541 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001542 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001543 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1544 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1545 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1546 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1547 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001548
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001549tune.buffers.limit <number>
1550 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1551 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1552 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1553 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1554 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001555 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001556 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1557 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1558 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1559 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1560 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1561 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1562 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1563 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1564 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1565
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001566tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1567 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1568 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1569 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1570 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1571
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001572tune.bufsize <number>
1573 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1574 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1575 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1576 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1577 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1578 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1579 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001580 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1581 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1582 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001583 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001584 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1585 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1586 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001587
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001588tune.chksize <number>
1589 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1590 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1591 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1592 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1593 checks whenever possible.
1594
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001595tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1596 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1597 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1598 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1599 this value. The default value is 1.
1600
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001601tune.fail-alloc
1602 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1603 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1604 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1605 gracefully.
1606
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001607tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1608 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1609 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1610 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1611 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1612 change it.
1613
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001614tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1615 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1617 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001618 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1619 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1620 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1621 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1622 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1623
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001624tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1625 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1626 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1627 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1628 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1629 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1630 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1631 recommended not to change this value.
1632
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001633tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1634 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1635 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1636 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1637 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1638 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1639 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1640 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1641
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001642tune.http.cookielen <number>
1643 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1644 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1645 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1646 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1647 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1648 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1649 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1650 to change this value.
1651
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001652tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001653 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1654 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001655 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001656 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001657 configuration directives too.
1658 The default value is 1024.
1659
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001660tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1661 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1662 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1663 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1664 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1665 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1666 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001667 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1668 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1669 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001670
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001671tune.idletimer <timeout>
1672 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1673 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1674 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1675 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1676 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1677 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001678 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001679 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1680 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1681
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001682tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1683 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1684 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1685 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1686 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1687 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1688 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1689 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1690 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1691 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1692
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001693tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1694 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001695 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001696 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1697 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001698 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001699 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1700 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1701
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001702tune.lua.maxmem
1703 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1704 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1705 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1706 memory.
1707
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001708tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1709 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001710 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1711 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001712 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001713
1714tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1715 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1716 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1717 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1718 check servers.
1719
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001720tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1721 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1722 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1723 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001725
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001726tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001727 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1728 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1729 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1730 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1731 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1732 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1733 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1734 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1735 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1736 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001737
1738tune.maxpollevents <number>
1739 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1740 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1741 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1742 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1743 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1744
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001745tune.maxrewrite <number>
1746 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1747 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1748 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1749 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1750 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1751 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1752 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1753 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1754 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1755 bufsize.
1756
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001757tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1758 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1759 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1760 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1761 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1762 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1763 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1764 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1765 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1766 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1767 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1768 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1769 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1770 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1771 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1772 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1773 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1774 setting this parameter to 0.
1775
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001776tune.pipesize <number>
1777 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1778 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1779 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1780 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1781 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1782 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1783
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001784tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1785 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1786 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1787 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1788 default is 20.
1789
1790tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1791 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1792 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1793 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1794 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1795 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1796 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1797 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1798
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001799tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1800tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1801 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1802 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1803 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1804 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001806 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1807 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1808
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001809tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001811 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1812 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1813 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1814 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1815
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001816tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1817 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1818 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1819 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1820
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001821tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1822tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1823 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1824 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1825 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1826 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001828 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1829 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1830 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1831 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1832 notifying haproxy again.
1833
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001834tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001835 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1836 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1837 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001838 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001839 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001840 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001841 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1842 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1843 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001844 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1845 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001846
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001847tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001848 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001849 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1850 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1851 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1852 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1853 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1854
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001855tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1856 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001857 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001858 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1859 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1860 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1861 being used for too long.
1862
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001863tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1864 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1865 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1866 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1867 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1868 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1869 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1870 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1871 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1872 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1873 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001874 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001875 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001876
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001877tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1878 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1879 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1880 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1881 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1882 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1883 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1884 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001885 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1886 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001887
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001888tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1889 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1890 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1891 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1892 1000 entries.
1893
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001894tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1895 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1896 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1897 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1898
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001899tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001900tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001901tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1902tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1903tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001904 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1905 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1906 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1907 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1908 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1909 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1910 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1911 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001912
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001913 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1914 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1915 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1916 all available space is consumed.
1917 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1918 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1919 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001920
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001921tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1922 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001923 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001924 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001925 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001926 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1927
1928tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1929 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1930 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1932 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019343.3. Debugging
1935--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001936
1937debug
1938 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1939 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1940 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1941 system startup.
1942
1943quiet
1944 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1945 line argument "-q".
1946
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019483.4. Userlists
1949--------------
1950It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1951http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1952it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1953
1954userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001955 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001956 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1957
1958group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001959 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001960 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1961 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1962
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001963user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1964 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001965 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1966 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001967 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1968 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1969 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1970 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001971
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001972 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1973 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1974 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1975 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1976 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1977 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1978 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1979 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1980 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
1982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001983 userlist L1
1984 group G1 users tiger,scott
1985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1988 user scott insecure-password elgato
1989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001991 userlist L2
1992 group G1
1993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001998
1999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002001
20023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002003----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002004It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2005several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2006instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2007values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2008automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2009In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2010using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2011tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2012reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2013Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2014that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2015each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002016
2017peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002018 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002021bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2022 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2023 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2024
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002025disabled
2026 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2027 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2028 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2029
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002030default-bind [param*]
2031 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2032
2033default-server [param*]
2034 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2035
2036 Arguments:
2037 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2038 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2039 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2040 details.
2041
2042
2043 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2044
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002045enable
2046 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2047
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002048peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002049 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2050 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2051 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2052 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2053 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2054 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2055
2056 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2057 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2058
2059 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2060 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2061 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2062 across all peers.
2063
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002064 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2065 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002066
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002067 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2068 "server" keyword explanation below).
2069
2070server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002071 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002072 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2073 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2074 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2075 of this "peers" section).
2076 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2077
2078
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002080 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002081 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002082 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2083 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2084 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002085
2086 backend mybackend
2087 mode tcp
2088 balance roundrobin
2089 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2090 stick on src
2091
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002092 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2093 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002094
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002095 Example:
2096 peers mypeers
2097 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2098 default-server ssl verify none
2099 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2100 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002102
2103table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2104 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2105
2106 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2107 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2108 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2109 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2110 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2111 "stick-table" keyword).
2112
2113 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2114 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2115 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2116 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2117 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2118 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2119 of the stick-table name as follows:
2120
2121 peers mypeers
2122 peer A ...
2123 peer B ...
2124 table t1 ...
2125
2126 frontend fe1
2127 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2128
2129 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2130 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2131
2132 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2133 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2134 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2135 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2136 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2137 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2138 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2139
2140 peers mypeers
2141 peer A ...
2142 peer B ...
2143 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2144
2145 backend t1
2146 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2147
2148 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2149 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2150 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2151
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021523.6. Mailers
2153------------
2154It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2155If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2156in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2157
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002158mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002159 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2160 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2161
2162mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2163 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2164
2165 Example:
2166 mailers mymailers
2167 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2168 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2169
2170 backend mybackend
2171 mode tcp
2172 balance roundrobin
2173
2174 email-alert mailers mymailers
2175 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2176 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2177
2178 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2179 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2180
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002181timeout mail <time>
2182 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2183 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2184 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2185 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2186
2187 Example:
2188 mailers mymailers
2189 timeout mail 20s
2190 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002191
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020021923.7. Programs
2193-------------
2194In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2195master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2196managed the same way as the workers.
2197
2198During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2199sequence as a worker:
2200
2201 - the master is re-executed
2202 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2203 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2204 instance of the program
2205
2206During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2207
2208program <name>
2209 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2210 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2211 the management guide).
2212
2213command <command> [arguments*]
2214 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2215 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2216 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2217 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2218
2219option start-on-reload
2220no option start-on-reload
2221 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2222 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2223 program section.
2224
2225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022264. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002229Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002230 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002231 - frontend <name>
2232 - backend <name>
2233 - listen <name>
2234
2235A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2236its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2237section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002238section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002239
2240A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2241connections.
2242
2243A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2244to forward incoming connections.
2245
2246A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2247parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2250'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2251case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2252
2253Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2254logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2255proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2256However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2257name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2258
2259Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2260and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002261bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2263modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2264arbitrary criteria.
2265
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002266In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2267a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002268the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002269
2270 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2271 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2272 between responses and new requests.
2273
2274 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2275 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2276 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002277 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2278 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2279 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2280 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002281
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002282 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2283 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2284 client-facing connection remains open.
2285
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002286 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2287 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002288
2289The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2290frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2291following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002292weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002293
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002294 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002296 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2297 ----+-----+-----+----
2298 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2299 ----+-----+-----+----
2300 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2301 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2302 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2303 ----+-----+-----+----
2304 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2309--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002311The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2312limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2313they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2314limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002315marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002316option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002317and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2318with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2319specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002322 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2323------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2324acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002325backlog X X X -
2326balance X - X X
2327bind - X X -
2328bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002329block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002330capture cookie - X X -
2331capture request header - X X -
2332capture response header - X X -
2333clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002334compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002335contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2336cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002337declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338default-server X - X X
2339default_backend X X X -
2340description - X X X
2341disabled X X X X
2342dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002343email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002344email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002345email-alert mailers X X X X
2346email-alert myhostname X X X X
2347email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002348enabled X X X X
2349errorfile X X X X
2350errorloc X X X X
2351errorloc302 X X X X
2352-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2353errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002354force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002355filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002356fullconn X - X X
2357grace X X X X
2358hash-type X - X X
2359http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002360http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002361http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002362http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002363http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002364http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002365http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002366id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002367ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002368load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002369log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002370log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002371log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002372log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002373max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002374maxconn X X X -
2375mode X X X X
2376monitor fail - X X -
2377monitor-net X X X -
2378monitor-uri X X X -
2379option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2380option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2381option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2382option allbackups (*) X - X X
2383option checkcache (*) X - X X
2384option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2385option contstats (*) X X X -
2386option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2387option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002388-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2389option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002390option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002391option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002392option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002393option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002394option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002395option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002396option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002398option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399option httpchk X - X X
2400option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002401option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002403option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002404option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002405option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2407option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2408option logasap (*) X X X -
2409option mysql-check X - X X
2410option nolinger (*) X X X X
2411option originalto X X X X
2412option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002413option pgsql-check X - X X
2414option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002416option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002417option smtpchk X - X X
2418option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2419option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2420option splice-request (*) X X X X
2421option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002422option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2424option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002426option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2428option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2429option tcpka X X X X
2430option tcplog X X X X
2431option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002432external-check command X - X X
2433external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2435rate-limit sessions X X X -
2436redirect - X X X
2437redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2438redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002439reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2440reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2441reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2442reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2443reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2444reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2445reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2446reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2447reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2448reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2449reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2450reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002452reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002453retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002454retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002455rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2456rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2457rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2458rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2459rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2460rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2461rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002463server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002464server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002465source X - X X
2466srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002467stats admin - X X X
2468stats auth X X X X
2469stats enable X X X X
2470stats hide-version X X X X
2471stats http-request - X X X
2472stats realm X X X X
2473stats refresh X X X X
2474stats scope X X X X
2475stats show-desc X X X X
2476stats show-legends X X X X
2477stats show-node X X X X
2478stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2480stick match - - X X
2481stick on - - X X
2482stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002483stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002484stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002485tcp-check connect - - X X
2486tcp-check expect - - X X
2487tcp-check send - - X X
2488tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002489tcp-request connection - X X -
2490tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002491tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002492tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002493tcp-response content - - X X
2494tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002495timeout check X - X X
2496timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002497timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002498timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2499timeout connect X - X X
2500timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2501timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2502timeout http-request X X X X
2503timeout queue X - X X
2504timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002505timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002506timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2507timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002508timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002509transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002510unique-id-format X X X -
2511unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002512use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002513use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2515 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2519---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520
2521This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2522
2523
2524acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2525 Declare or complete an access list.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 no | yes | yes | yes
2528 Example:
2529 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2530 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2531 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002533 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
2535
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002536backlog <conns>
2537 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2539 yes | yes | yes | no
2540 Arguments :
2541 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2542 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002543 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002544
2545 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2546 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2547 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2548 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2549 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2550 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2551 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2552 backlog parameter.
2553
2554 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2555 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2556 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2557
2558 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2559
2560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002562balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002563 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2565 yes | no | yes | yes
2566 Arguments :
2567 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2568 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2569 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2570 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2571
2572 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2573 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2574 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2575 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002576 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002577 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002578 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2579 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2580 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2581 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2582 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2583 it, so that you don't worry.
2584
2585 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2586 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2587 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2588 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2589 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2590 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2591 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2592 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002594 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2595 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2596 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2597 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2598 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2599 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2600 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2601 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2602
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002603 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002604 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002605 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2606 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002607 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002608 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2609 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2610 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2611 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2612 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002613 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2614 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2615 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2616 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2617 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2618 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2621 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2622 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2623 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2624 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2625 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2626 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2627 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002628 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002630 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2631 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2632 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002634 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2635 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2636 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2637 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2638 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2639 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2640 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2641 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2642 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2643 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2644 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2645 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002647 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002648 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2649 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2650 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2651 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2652 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2653 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2654 URIs start with a leading "/".
2655
2656 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2657 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2658 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2659 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002662 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2663
2664 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002665 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2666 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002667 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2668 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2669 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2670 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002671 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002672 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2673 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002674
2675 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2676 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2677 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2678 server will receive the request.
2679
2680 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2681 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2682 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2683 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2684 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002685 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2686 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2687 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002689 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2690 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2691 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2692 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2693 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002695 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002696 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2697 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2698 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2699
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2701 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2702 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2703
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002704 random
2705 random(<draws>)
2706 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002707 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2708 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2709 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2710 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002711 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2712 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2713 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2714 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2715 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2716 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2717 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2718 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2719 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2720 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2721 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2722 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2723 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2724 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2725 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2726 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2727 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2728 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2729 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2730 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002731
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002732 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002733 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002734 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2735 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2736 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2737 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2738 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2739 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002740 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002741 used instead.
2742
2743 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2744 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2745 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2746 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2747
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002748 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2749 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2750 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2751
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002752 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002755 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2756 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002757
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002758 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2759 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2760 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002762 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2763 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2764 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2765 NTLM relies on.
2766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767 Examples :
2768 balance roundrobin
2769 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002770 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002771 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2772 balance hdr(host)
2773 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002774
2775 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2776 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002778 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002779 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2780 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2781 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2782 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2783
2784 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2785 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2786 defaults to 16 kB.
2787
2788 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2789 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2790
2791 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2792 Round Robin.
2793
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002794 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002795 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2796 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2797 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2798
2799 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2800
2801 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002802 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002803 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2804 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2805 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002807 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002810bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2811bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002812 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 no | yes | yes | no
2815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002816 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2817 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2818 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2819 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002820 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002821 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2822 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2823 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2824 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2825 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2826 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2827 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002828 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2829 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2830 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2831 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2832 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2833 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2834 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002835 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2836 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2837 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002838 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2839 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2840 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2841 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002842 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2843 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2844 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002845
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002846 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2847 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002848 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2849 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2850 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002851 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2852 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2853 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2854 the range.
2855
2856 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2857 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2858 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2859 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2860 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2861 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2862 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002863 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002864 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002866 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002867 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002868 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2869 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2870 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2871 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2872 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2873 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002875 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2876 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2877 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2878 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2881 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2882 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2883 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2884 in a frontend.
2885
2886 Example :
2887 listen http_proxy
2888 bind :80,:443
2889 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002890 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002892 listen http_https_proxy
2893 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002894 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002895
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002896 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2897 bind ipv6@:80
2898 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2899 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2900
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002901 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002902 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002903
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002904 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2905 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2906 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2907 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2908 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2909
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002910 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002911 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
2913
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002914bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002915 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | yes
2918 Arguments :
2919 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2920 may be used to override a default value.
2921
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002922 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002923 option may be combined with other numbers.
2924
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002925 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002926 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2927 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2928 missing from all processes.
2929
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002930 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002931 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002932 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2933 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2934 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2935 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2936 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002937 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002938
2939 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2940 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2941 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2942 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2943 and 'even' instances.
2944
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002945 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2946 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2947 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2948 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002949
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002950 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2951 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2952
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002953 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2954 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2955 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2956
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002957 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2958 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen app_ip1
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002963 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002964
2965 listen app_ip2
2966 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002967 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002968
2969 listen management
2970 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002971 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002972
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002973 listen management
2974 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2975 bind-process 1-4
2976
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002977 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002978
2979
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002980block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 no | yes | yes | yes
2984
2985 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2986 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002987 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002988 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002990 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2991 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2992 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002994 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2995 "http-request deny" instead.
2996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 Example:
2998 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2999 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3000 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003001 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3002 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3003 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003005 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3006 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3007 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
3009capture cookie <name> len <length>
3010 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 no | yes | yes | no
3013 Arguments :
3014 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3015 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3016 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3017 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003018 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019
3020 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3021 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3022 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3023 right if it exceeds <length>.
3024
3025 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3026 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3027 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3028 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3029
3030 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3031 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3032 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3033
3034 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3035 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3036 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003037 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3038 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3039 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
3041 Example:
3042 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3043
3044 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003045 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046
3047
3048capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003049 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 no | yes | yes | no
3052 Arguments :
3053 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3056 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3057 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3058
3059 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3060 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3061 it exceeds <length>.
3062
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003063 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3065 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003066 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3067 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3068 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3069 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003070 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003071 environments to find where the request came from.
3072
3073 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3074 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3075 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3076 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003078 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3079 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3080 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3081 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3082 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
3084 Example:
3085 capture request header Host len 15
3086 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003087 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 about logging.
3091
3092
3093capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003094 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 no | yes | yes | no
3097 Arguments :
3098 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003099 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3101 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3102 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3103
3104 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3105 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3106 it exceeds <length>.
3107
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003108 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3110 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3111 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003112 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3113 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3114 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3115 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003117 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3118 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3119 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3120 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3121 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123 Example:
3124 capture response header Content-length len 9
3125 capture response header Location len 15
3126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003127 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 about logging.
3129
3130
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003131clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 yes | yes | yes | no
3135 Arguments :
3136 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3137 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3138 as explained at the top of this document.
3139
3140 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3141 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3142 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3143 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3144 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3145 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3146 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3147 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003148 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003150 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
3152 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3154 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3155 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3156 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3157 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3158
3159 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3160 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3161
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003162 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3163 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003165compression algo <algorithm> ...
3166compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003167compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003168 Enable HTTP compression.
3169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | yes | yes | yes
3171 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003172 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3173 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3174 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3175
3176 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003177 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3178 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3179 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003180
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003181 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003182 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003183
3184 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3185 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3186 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3187 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3188 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003189 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003190
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003191 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3192 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3193 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3194 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3195 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3196 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3197 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003198 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003199
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003200 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003201 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003202 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3203 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3204 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3205 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3206 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003207
3208 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3209 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3210 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3211 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3212 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003213 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3214 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3215 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3216 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3217 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003218 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3219 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003220
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003221 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003222 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3223 "Accept-Encoding" header
3224 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003225 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003226 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3227 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3228 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3229 "multipart"
3230 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3231 header
3232 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3233 and later
3234 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3235 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003236 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003237
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003238 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003239
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003240 Examples :
3241 compression algo gzip
3242 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003245contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3248 yes | no | yes | yes
3249 Arguments :
3250 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3251 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3252 as explained at the top of this document.
3253
3254 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003255 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003256 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003257 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003258 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3259 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3260 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3261
3262 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3263 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3264 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3265 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3266 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3267 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3268
3269 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3270 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3271 instead.
3272
3273 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3274 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3275
3276
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003277cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003278 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3279 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003280 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003281 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | no | yes | yes
3284 Arguments :
3285 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3286 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3287 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3288 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3289 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3290 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3293 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3294
3295 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3296 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3297 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3298 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3299 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3300 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003301 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3302 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003303 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003304 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3305 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003308 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003309
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003310 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003311 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003312 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003313 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003314 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3315 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3316 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3317 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3318 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3319 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3320 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321
3322 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3323 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3324 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3325 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3326 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3327 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3328 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3329 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3330 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003331 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003332 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3333 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3334 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003336 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3337 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3338 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003339 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3340 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3341 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3342 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003343 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3344 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3345 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346
3347 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3348 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3349 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3350 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3351 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3352 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3353 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3354 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3355 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3356
3357 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3358 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3359 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3360 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3361 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3362 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3363 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3364 persistence cookie in the cache.
3365 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3366
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003367 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3368 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3369 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3370 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3371 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003372 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003373 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3374 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3375 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3376 they logout.
3377
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003378 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3379 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3380 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3381 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3382
3383 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3384 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3385 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3386 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3387 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3388 this attribute.
3389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003390 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003391 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003392 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3393 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3394 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3395 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3396 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3397 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003399 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3400 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3401 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3402 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3403 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3404 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3405 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3406 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003407 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003408 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3409 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3410 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3411 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3412 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3413 the site.
3414
3415 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3416 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3417 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3418 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3419 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3420 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3421 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3422 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3423 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3424 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3425 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3426 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3427 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003428 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003429 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3430 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3431
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003432 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3433 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3434 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3435 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3436 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3437 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3440 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3441 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3442 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444 Examples :
3445 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3446 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3447 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003448 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003450 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003452
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003453declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3454 Declares a capture slot.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 no | yes | yes | no
3457 Arguments:
3458 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3459
3460 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3461 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3462 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3463 for use in the response.
3464
3465 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003466 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003467 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3468
3469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003470default-server [param*]
3471 Change default options for a server in a backend
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | no | yes | yes
3474 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003475 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3476 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3477 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3478 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003479
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003480 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003481 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3482
3483 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486default_backend <backend>
3487 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 yes | yes | yes | no
3490 Arguments :
3491 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3492
3493 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3494 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3495 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3496 will catch all undetermined requests.
3497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498 Example :
3499
3500 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3501 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3502 default_backend dynamic
3503
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003504 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003507description <string>
3508 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3510 no | yes | yes | yes
3511 Arguments : string
3512
3513 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3514 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3515 it describes.
3516 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3517
3518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519disabled
3520 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | yes
3523 Arguments : none
3524
3525 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3526 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3527 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3528 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3529 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3530 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3531 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3532
3533 See also : "enabled"
3534
3535
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003536dispatch <address>:<port>
3537 Set a default server address
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003541
3542 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3543 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3544 during start-up.
3545
3546 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3547 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3548 possible with normal servers.
3549
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003550 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003551 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3552 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3553 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3554 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3555
3556 See also : "server"
3557
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003558
3559dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3560 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 yes | no | yes | yes
3563 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3564
3565 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003566 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003567 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3568 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003570 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572enabled
3573 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | yes | yes | yes
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3579 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3580
3581 See also : "disabled"
3582
3583
3584errorfile <code> <file>
3585 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments :
3589 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003590 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3591 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592
3593 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003594 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003596 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3597 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598
3599 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3600 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3601 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3602
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003603 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3606 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3607 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3608 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3609
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003610 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3611 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003613 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3614 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3615 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3618 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3619 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003620 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3622
3623 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3624
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003625 Example :
3626 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003627 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003628 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3629 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
3632errorloc <code> <url>
3633errorloc302 <code> <url>
3634 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | yes | yes | yes
3637 Arguments :
3638 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003639 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3640 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3643 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3644 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3645 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003646 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3649 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3650 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3651
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003652 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3655 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3656 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3657 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003658 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3660 request.
3661
3662 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3663
3664
3665errorloc303 <code> <url>
3666 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
3669 Arguments :
3670 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003671 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3672 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003673
3674 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3675 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3676 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3677 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003678 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003679
3680 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3681 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3682 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3683
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003684 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3687 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3688 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3689 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003690 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003691
3692 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3693
3694
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003695email-alert from <emailaddr>
3696 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003697 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700
3701 Arguments :
3702
3703 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3704
3705 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3706 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3707
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003708 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003709 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3710 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003711
3712
3713email-alert level <level>
3714 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3715 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
3718
3719 Arguments :
3720
3721 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3722 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3723 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3724
3725 By default level is alert
3726
3727 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3728 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3729 for the proxy.
3730
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003731 Alerts are sent when :
3732
3733 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3734 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3735 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3736 is notice or lower
3737 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3738 and a health check status update occurs
3739
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003740 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3741 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003742 section 3.6 about mailers.
3743
3744
3745email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3746 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3748 yes | yes | yes | yes
3749
3750 Arguments :
3751
3752 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3753
3754 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3755 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3756
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003757 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3758 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003759
3760
3761email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3762 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3763 mailers.
3764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766
3767 Arguments :
3768
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003769 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003770
3771 By default the systems hostname is used.
3772
3773 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3774 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3775 for the proxy.
3776
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003777 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3778 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003779
3780
3781email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003782 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003783 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | yes | yes | yes
3786
3787 Arguments :
3788
3789 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3790
3791 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3792 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3793
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003794 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003795 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3796
3797
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003798force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3799 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003801 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003802
3803 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3804 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3805 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3806 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3807 marked down for maintenance operations.
3808
3809 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3810 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3811 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3812 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3813 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3814 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3815 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3816 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3817 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3818
3819 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3820 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3821 is used.
3822
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003823 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003824 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003825
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003826
3827filter <name> [param*]
3828 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 no | yes | yes | yes
3831 Arguments :
3832 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3833 referenced in section 9.
3834
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003835 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003836 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003837 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3838 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003839
3840 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3841 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3842
3843 Example:
3844 listen
3845 bind *:80
3846
3847 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3848 filter compression
3849 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3850
3851 compression algo gzip
3852 compression offload
3853
3854 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3855
3856 See also : section 9.
3857
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859fullconn <conns>
3860 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | no | yes | yes
3863 Arguments :
3864 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3865 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3866
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003867 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003869 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003870 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3871 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3872 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3873 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3874 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003875 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003877 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3878 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003879 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3880 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3881 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003882
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003883 Example :
3884 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3885 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3886 # connections.
3887 backend dynamic
3888 fullconn 10000
3889 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3890 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3891
3892 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3893
3894
3895grace <time>
3896 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003899 Arguments :
3900 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3901 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3902 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3903
3904 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3905 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003906 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003907 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3908
3909 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3910 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3911 simplify it.
3912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003914hash-balance-factor <factor>
3915 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | no | no | yes
3918 Arguments :
3919 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3920 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003921 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003922
3923 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3924 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3925 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3926 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3927 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3928 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3929 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3930
3931 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3932 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3933 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3934 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3935 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3936
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003937 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3938 consistent hashing mechanism.
3939
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003940 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3941
3942
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003943hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003944 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3946 yes | no | yes | yes
3947 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003948 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3949 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003950
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003951 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3952 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3953 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3954 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3955 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3956 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3957 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3958 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3959 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3960 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003961
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003962 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3963 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3964 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3965 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3966 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3967 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3968 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3969 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3970 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3971 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3972 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3973 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3974 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003975 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3976 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003977
3978 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3979
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003980 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003981 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3982 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3983 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003984 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3985 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3986 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003987
3988 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3989 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003990 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3991 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3992 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3993 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3994
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003995 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3996 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3997 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3998 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3999 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4000 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4001 parameter.
4002
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004003 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4004 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4005 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4006 used on strings.
4007
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004008 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4009
4010 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4011 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4012 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4013 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4014 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4015 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4016 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4017 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4018 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4019 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4020 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4021 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004023 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4024 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4025 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004026
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004027 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
4029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004030http-check disable-on-404
4031 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034 Arguments : none
4035
4036 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4037 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4038 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4039 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4040 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4041 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4042 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4043 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4045 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4046 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4047
4048 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4049
4050
4051http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004052 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004054 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 Arguments :
4056 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4057 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004058 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004059 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4060 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4061 details on the supported keywords.
4062
4063 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4064 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4065 with the usual backslash ('\').
4066
4067 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4068 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4069 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4070 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4071 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4072
4073 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4076 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4077 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4078
4079 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004080 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4082 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4083 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4084 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4085
4086 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004087 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004088 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4089 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4090 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4091 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4092 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004093 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004094 trace).
4095
4096 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004097 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4099 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4100 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4101 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4102 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004103 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004104
4105 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4106 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4107 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4108 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4109 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4110 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4111 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4112 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4113
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004114 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4115 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4116 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4117
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4119 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4120
4121 Examples :
4122 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004123 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004124
4125 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004126 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004127
4128 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004129 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004130
4131 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004132 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004135
4136
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004137http-check send-state
4138 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4140 yes | no | yes | yes
4141 Arguments : none
4142
4143 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4144 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4145 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4146 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4147 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4148
4149 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4150 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4151 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4152 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4153 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004154 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4155 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4156 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4157
4158 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4159 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4160 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4161
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004162 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4163 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4164 checked in multiple backends.
4165
4166 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4167 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4168
4169 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4170 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4171 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4172 one fails.
4173
4174 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4175 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4176 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4177
4178 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4179 server's queue.
4180
4181 Example of a header received by the application server :
4182 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4183 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4184
4185 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187
4188http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004189 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4190
4191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 no | yes | yes | yes
4193
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004194 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4195 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4196 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4197 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4198 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4201 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4206 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4207 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4208 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4211 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4212 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4213 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215 Example:
4216 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4217 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4218 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 http-request allow if nagios
4221 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4222 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4223 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 Example:
4226 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4227 acl add path /addacl
4228 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4233 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 Example:
4236 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4237 acl setmap path /setmap
4238 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4243 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4246 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4251 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4252 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4253 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4254 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4255 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4256 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4257 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4262 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4263 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4264 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4265 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4266 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4267 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4268 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4273 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004274
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4279 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4280 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4281 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4282 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 Example:
4285 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4286 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004288http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4296 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4297 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4298 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4299 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4300 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4301 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4302 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4303 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4306 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4307 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4308 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4309 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4310 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4315 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4316 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4317 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4318 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4319 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4328 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4329 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4330 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4331 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4332 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4337 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4338 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4339 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4340 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004341
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004342http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4343 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4344 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4345 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4346
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004347http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4348
4349 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4350 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4351 pointed by <resolvers>.
4352 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4353 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4354 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4355 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4356 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4357 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4358 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4359 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4360 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4361 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4362 to 0.0.0.0.
4363
4364 Example:
4365 resolvers mydns
4366 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4367 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4368 timeout retry 1s
4369 hold valid 10s
4370 hold nx 3s
4371 hold other 3s
4372 hold obsolete 0s
4373 accepted_payload_size 8192
4374
4375 frontend fe
4376 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4377 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4378 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4379
4380 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4381 # which mean DNS resolution error
4382 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4383
4384 default_backend be
4385
4386 backend b_503
4387 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4388 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4389 # 503 error page to end users
4390
4391 backend be
4392 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4393 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4394 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4395 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4396 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4397
4398 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4399 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4400
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004401http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4402
4403 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4404 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4405 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4406 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004407 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4408 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004409
4410 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4415 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4416 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4417 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4418 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4423 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4424 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4425 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4428 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4431 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4432 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4433 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4434 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4435 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4436 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4437 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 Example:
4440 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 # applied to:
4443 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 # outputs:
4446 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4454 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4455 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4456 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 Example:
4459 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461 # applied to:
4462 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 # outputs:
4465 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4471 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4472 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004476 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4477 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4478 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4483 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4484 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4485 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4486 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 Arguments:
4489 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4490 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 Example:
4493 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4494 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4497 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4502 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4503 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 Arguments:
4506 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4507 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509 Example:
4510 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4511 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4514 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4515 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4520 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4521 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4522 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4523 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 Example:
4526 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4527 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4528 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4539 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4540 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4541 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4542 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4548 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4549 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4550 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4551 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4552 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4553 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4554 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4555 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4560 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4561 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4562 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4563 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4564 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4565 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4570 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4571 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004575 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4576 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4577 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4578 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4579 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4580 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4581 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4582 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4587 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4588 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4589 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4590 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4591 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593 Example :
4594 # prepend the host name before the path
4595 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4600 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4601 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4602 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4603 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004605http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4608 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4609 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4610 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4611 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4612 values have higher priority.
4613 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4614 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4615 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4616 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4617 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4622 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4623 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4624 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4625 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4626 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4627 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004630
4631 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4633 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4636 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4637 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4638 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4639 privacy.
4640
4641 Arguments :
4642 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4643 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004644
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004645 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4647 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4648
4649 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4650 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4651
4652http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4653
4654 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4655 expression.
4656
4657 Arguments:
4658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4659 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004660
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004661 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4663 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4664
4665 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4666 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4667 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4668
4669http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4670
4671 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4672 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4673 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4674 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4675 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4676 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4677 information from the request.
4678
4679 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4680
4681http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4682
4683 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4684 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4685 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4686 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4687 path and the query string.
4688 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4689
4690http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4691
4692 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4693 inline.
4694
4695 Arguments:
4696 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4697 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4701 (request and response)
4702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4703 processing
4704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4705 processing
4706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4707 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4708 and '_'.
4709
4710 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4711 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004712
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004713 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4720 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4721 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4722 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4723 agent name must be used.
4724
4725 Arguments:
4726 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4727
4728 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4729 configuration.
4730
4731http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4732
4733 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4734 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4735 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4736 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4737 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4738 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4739 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4740 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4741 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4742 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4743 action.
4744 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4745 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4746 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4747 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4748 you fully understand how it works.
4749
4750http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4751
4752 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4753 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4754 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4755 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4756 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4757 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4758 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4759 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4760 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4761 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4762 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4763 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4764 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4765
4766http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4767http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4768http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769
4770 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4771 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4772 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4773 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4774 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4775 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4776 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4777 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4778 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4779 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4780 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4781 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4782
4783 Arguments :
4784 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4785 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4786 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4787 select which table entry to update the counters.
4788
4789 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4790 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4791 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4792 that table until the session ends.
4793
4794 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4795 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4796 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4797 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4798 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4799 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4800 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4801 useful information.
4802
4803 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4804 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4805 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4806 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4807 checks that make use of it.
4808
4809http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4810
4811 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004812
4813 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4819 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4820 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004821
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004824 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4825
4826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 no | yes | yes | yes
4828
4829 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4830 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4831 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4832 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4833 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4834 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4837 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4842 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4843 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4844 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4847 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4848 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4849 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 Example:
4852 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004856 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4857 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004859 Example:
4860 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004862 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4865 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4868 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004872 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4873 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4874 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4875 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4876 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4877 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4878 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4879 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4884 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4885 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4886 example, or to pass some internal information.
4887 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4888 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4889 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4894 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004895
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004896http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4903 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4904 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4905 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4906 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4907 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4908 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4911 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4912 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4913 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4914 keyword.
4915 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4916 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4922 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4923 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4924 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4925 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004931http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4934 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4935 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4936 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4937 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4938 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4943 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4948 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4949 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4950 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4951 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4952 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4955 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4958 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4959 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4960 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4961 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4962 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4963 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4964 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966 Example:
4967 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004969 # applied to:
4970 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 # outputs:
4973 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4978 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4981 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4982 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4983 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 Example:
4986 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004988 # applied to:
4989 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991 # outputs:
4992 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4995http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004997 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4998 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4999 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5004 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5005 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005009 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5010 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5011 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5012 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5013 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015 Arguments:
5016 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5019 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005023 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5024 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5025 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5028
5029 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5030 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5031 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5032 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5033 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5034
5035http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5036
5037 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5038 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5039 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5040 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5041 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5042 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5043 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5044 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5045 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5046
5047http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5048
5049 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5050 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5051 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5052 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5053 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5054 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5055 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5056
5057http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5058
5059 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5060 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5061 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5062 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5063 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5064 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5065 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5066 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5067
5068http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5070
5071 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5072 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5073 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5074 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005075
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005076 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005077 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5078 http-response set-status 431
5079 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5080 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005082http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5085 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5086 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5087 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5088 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5089 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5090 based on some information from the request.
5091
5092 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5093
5094http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5095
5096 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5097 inline.
5098
5099 Arguments:
5100 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5101 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5102 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5103 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5104 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5105 (request and response)
5106 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5107 processing
5108 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5109 processing
5110 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5111 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5112 and '_'.
5113
5114 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5115 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005116
5117 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005122 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5123 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5124 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5125 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5126 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5127 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5128 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5129 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5130 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5131 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5132 action.
5133 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5134 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5135 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5136 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5137 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005139http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5140http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5141http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5144 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5145 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5146 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5147 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5148 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5149
5150http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5151
5152 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5153 about <var-name>.
5154
5155 Example:
5156 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5157
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005158
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005159http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5160 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5161
5162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | no | yes | yes
5164
5165 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005166 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5167 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5168 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005169
5170 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5171
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005172 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5173 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5174 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5175 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5176 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5177 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5178 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5179 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5180 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5181 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005182
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005183 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5184 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5185 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5186 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5187 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5188 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5189 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5190 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005191
5192 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5193 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5194 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5195 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5196 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5197 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5198 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5199 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005200 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005201 downsides of rare connection failures.
5202
5203 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5204 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5205 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5206 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5207 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5208 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005209 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005210 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5211 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5212 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5213 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5214 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5215
5216 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005217 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5218 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5219 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005220
5221 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005222 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005223
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005224 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5225 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005226
5227 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5228 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5229 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5230
5231 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5232 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5233 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5234
5235 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5236
5237
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005238http-send-name-header [<header>]
5239 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5240
5241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | no | yes | yes
5243
5244 Arguments :
5245
5246 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5247
5248 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005249 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005250 is added with the header string proved.
5251
5252 See also : "server"
5253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005254id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005255 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5257 no | yes | yes | yes
5258 Arguments : none
5259
5260 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5261 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5262 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005263
5264
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005265ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5266 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005268 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005269
5270 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5271 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5272 and running).
5273
5274 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5275 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5276 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005277 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005278 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5279
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005280 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5281 "unless" condition is met.
5282
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005283 Example:
5284 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5285 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5286 ignore-persist if url_static
5287
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005288 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5289
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005290load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5291 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | no | yes | yes
5294
5295 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5296 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5297 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005298 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005299 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5300 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5301 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5302 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5303
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005304 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005305 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005306 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005307
5308 Arguments:
5309 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5310 named "server-state-file".
5311
5312 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5313 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5314 name is used as a file name.
5315
5316 none don't load any stat for this backend
5317
5318 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005319 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5320 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5321 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005322 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005323 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005324
5325 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5326 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5327
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005328 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005329
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005330 global
5331 stats socket /tmp/socket
5332 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005333
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005334 defaults
5335 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005336
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005337 backend bk
5338 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5339 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005340
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005341
5342 Then one can run :
5343
5344 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5345
5346 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5347
5348 1
5349 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5350 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5351 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5352
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005353 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005354
5355 global
5356 stats socket /tmp/socket
5357 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5358
5359 defaults
5360 load-server-state-from-file local
5361
5362 backend bk
5363 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5364 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5365
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005366
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005367 Then one can run :
5368
5369 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5370
5371 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5372
5373 1
5374 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5375 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5376 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5377
5378 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5379 "show servers state"
5380
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005381
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005382log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005383log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5384 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005385no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005386 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005389
5390 Prefix :
5391 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5392 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5393 prefix does not allow arguments.
5394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005395 Arguments :
5396 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5397 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5398 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5399 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5400 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5401 parameter.
5402
5403 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5404 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5405
5406 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5407 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5408 standard syslog port).
5409
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005410 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5411 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5412 standard syslog port).
5413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005414 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5415 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5416 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005417 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005418
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005419 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5420 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5421 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5422 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5423 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5424 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5425 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5426 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5427 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5428 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5429 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5430 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5431 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5432 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5433 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5434 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005435 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5436 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005437
5438 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5439 and "fd@2", see above.
5440
5441 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5442 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005443
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005444 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5445 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5446 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5447 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5448 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5449 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5450 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5451 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5452 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5453 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005454 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005455
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005456 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5457 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5458 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5459 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5460 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5461
5462 <sample_size>
5463 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5464 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5465 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5466 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5467 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5468
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005469 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5470 one of the following :
5471
5472 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5473 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5474
5475 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5476 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5477
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005478 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5479 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5480 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5481 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5482 systemd logger consumes.
5483
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005484 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5485 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5486 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5487 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5490
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005491 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5492 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5493 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5494
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005495 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5496 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5497 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5498 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005499
5500 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5501 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5502 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005503 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5504 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5505 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5506 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5507 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005508
5509 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5510
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005511 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5512 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5513 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005514
5515 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5516 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5517 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5518 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5519
5520 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5521 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005522
5523 Example :
5524 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005525 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5526 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5527 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005528 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5529 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005530 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005533log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005534 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5535 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5536 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005537
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005538 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5539 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5540 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5541 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5542 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005543
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005544 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5545 "option httplog" directives.
5546
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005547log-format-sd <string>
5548 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5550 yes | yes | yes | no
5551
5552 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5553 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5554 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5555 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5556 which covers the log format string in depth.
5557
5558 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5559 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5560
5561 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5562 log format to "rfc5424".
5563
5564 Example :
5565 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5566
5567
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005568log-tag <string>
5569 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | yes | yes | yes
5572
5573 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5574 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5575 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5576 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5577 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5578 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5579 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5580 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5581 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005582
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005583max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5584 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587
5588 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5589 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5590 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5591 servers.
5592
5593 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5594 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5595 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5596 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5597 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005598 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005599 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5600 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5601 picking a different server.
5602
5603 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5604 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5605 even if they have to be queued.
5606
5607 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5608 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5609
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005610max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5611 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5612 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5613 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005614
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005615maxconn <conns>
5616 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | yes | yes | no
5619 Arguments :
5620 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5621 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5622 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5623 closes.
5624
5625 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5626 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5627 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5628 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005629 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5630 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5631 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5632 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005633
5634 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5635 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5636 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5637
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005638 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5639 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005640
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005641 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5642
5643
5644mode { tcp|http|health }
5645 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5647 yes | yes | yes | yes
5648 Arguments :
5649 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5650 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5651 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5652 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5653
5654 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5655 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5656 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5657 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5658 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5659
5660 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005661 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5662 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5663 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5664 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5665 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5666 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5667 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005669 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5670 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5671 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005673 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005674 defaults http_instances
5675 mode http
5676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005677 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005679
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005680monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005681 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005684 Arguments :
5685 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5686 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005687 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005688 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5689 backend and its backup.
5690
5691 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5692 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5693 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5694 servers in a list of backends.
5695
5696 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5697 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5698 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5699 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5700 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5701 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5702 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005703 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5704 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005705
5706 Example:
5707 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005708 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005709 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5710 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5711 monitor-uri /site_alive
5712 monitor fail if site_dead
5713
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005714 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005715
5716
5717monitor-net <source>
5718 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5720 yes | yes | yes | no
5721 Arguments :
5722 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5723 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5724 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5725 followed by a mask.
5726
5727 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5728 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005729 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5731
5732 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5733 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5734 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5735 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005736 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5737 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5738 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005739
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005740 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5741 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5742 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5743 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5744 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5745 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005746
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005747 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5748 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005750 Example :
5751 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5752 frontend www
5753 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5754
5755 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5756
5757
5758monitor-uri <uri>
5759 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5761 yes | yes | yes | no
5762 Arguments :
5763 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5764 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5765
5766 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5767 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5768 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5769 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5770 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5771 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5772 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5773 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5774
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005775 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5776 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5777 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5778 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5779 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5780 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5781 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5782 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005783
5784 Example :
5785 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5786 frontend www
5787 mode http
5788 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5789
5790 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005792
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005793option abortonclose
5794no option abortonclose
5795 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | no | yes | yes
5798 Arguments : none
5799
5800 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5801 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5802 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5803 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005804 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005805 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5806 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5807 encountered while delivering the response.
5808
5809 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5810 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5811 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5812 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5813 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5814 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005815 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005816 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005817 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005818 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5819 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5820 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005822 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5823 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005824 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5825 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5826 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5827 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5828 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5829 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005830 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005831
5832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5834
5835 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5836
5837
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005838option accept-invalid-http-request
5839no option accept-invalid-http-request
5840 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5842 yes | yes | yes | no
5843 Arguments : none
5844
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005845 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005846 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005847 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005848 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5849 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5850 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5851 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5852 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005853 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5854 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5855 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5856 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005857 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005858 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005859 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5860 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5861 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005862
5863 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5864 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5865 been confirmed.
5866
5867 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5868 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005869 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5870 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005871 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5872
5873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5875
5876 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5877 stats socket.
5878
5879
5880option accept-invalid-http-response
5881no option accept-invalid-http-response
5882 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 yes | no | yes | yes
5885 Arguments : none
5886
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005887 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005888 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005889 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005890 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5891 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5892 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5893 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5894 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005895 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5896 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5897 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005898
5899 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5900 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5901 been confirmed.
5902
5903 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5904 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5905 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5906 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5907
5908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5910
5911 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5912 stats socket.
5913
5914
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005915option allbackups
5916no option allbackups
5917 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5919 yes | no | yes | yes
5920 Arguments : none
5921
5922 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5923 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5924 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5925 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5926 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5927 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5928 order between the backup servers anymore.
5929
5930 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5931 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5932
5933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5935
5936
5937option checkcache
5938no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005939 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5941 yes | no | yes | yes
5942 Arguments : none
5943
5944 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5945 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005946 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005947 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5948 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005949 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005950
5951 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005952 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005953 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005954 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5955 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005956 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005957 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005958 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5959 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005960 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005961 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5962 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005963 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005964 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5965 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5966 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5967 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5968 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5969 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5970 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5971 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5972 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5973
5974 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005975 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005976 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005977 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005978 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5979
5980 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5981 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005982 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005983 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005984
5985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5987
5988
5989option clitcpka
5990no option clitcpka
5991 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 yes | yes | yes | no
5994 Arguments : none
5995
5996 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5997 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005998 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005999 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6000
6001 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6002 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6003 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6004 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6005
6006 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6007 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6008 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6009 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6010 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6011
6012 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6013
6014 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6015 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6016 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6017
6018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6020
6021 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6022
6023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006024option contstats
6025 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 yes | yes | yes | no
6028 Arguments : none
6029
6030 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6031 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6032 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6033 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006034 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6035 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6036 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6037 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6038 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006039
6040
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006041option dontlog-normal
6042no option dontlog-normal
6043 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | yes | yes | no
6046 Arguments : none
6047
6048 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6049 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6050 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6051 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6052 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6053 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6054 logged.
6055
6056 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6057 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6058 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006060 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006061 logging.
6062
6063
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006064option dontlognull
6065no option dontlognull
6066 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | yes | yes | no
6069 Arguments : none
6070
6071 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6072 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6073 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6074 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6075 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6076 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006077 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6078 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6079 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006080
6081 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006082 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006083 would not be logged.
6084
6085 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6086 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6087
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006088 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6089 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006090
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006091
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006092option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006093 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | yes | yes | yes
6096 Arguments :
6097 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6098 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006099 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006100 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006101
6102 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6103 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6104 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6105 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6106 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6107 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6108 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006109 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6110 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6111 possible that the client has already brought one.
6112
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006113 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006114 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006115 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006116 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006117 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006118 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006119
6120 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6121 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6122 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6123 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6124 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6125 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6126 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6127
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006128 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6129 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6130 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6131 are under the control of the end-user.
6132
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006133 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006134 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6135 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006136 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6137 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6138 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006139
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006140 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006141 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6142 frontend www
6143 mode http
6144 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6145
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006146 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6147 backend www
6148 mode http
6149 option forwardfor header X-Client
6150
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006151 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006152 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006153
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006154
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006155option http-buffer-request
6156no option http-buffer-request
6157 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6159 yes | yes | yes | yes
6160 Arguments : none
6161
6162 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6163 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6164 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6165 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6166 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6167 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6168 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6169 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006170 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006171 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6172 default.
6173
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006174 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006175
6176
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006177option http-ignore-probes
6178no option http-ignore-probes
6179 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | yes | yes | no
6182 Arguments : none
6183
6184 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6185 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6186 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6187 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6188 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6189 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6190 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6191 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6192 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006193 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6194 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006195 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6196
6197 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6198 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6199 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6200 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6201 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6202 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6203 are often the only way to detect them.
6204
6205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6207
6208 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6209
6210
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006211option http-keep-alive
6212no option http-keep-alive
6213 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 yes | yes | yes | yes
6216 Arguments : none
6217
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006218 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6219 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006220 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6221 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6222 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6223 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6224 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006225
6226 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6227 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006228 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6229 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6230 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6231 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6232 situations where this option may be useful :
6233
6234 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006235 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006236
6237 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6238 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6239
6240 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6241 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6242 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6243 request.
6244
6245 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6246 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006247 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6248 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6249 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006250
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006251 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6252 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6253 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6254 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6255 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6256 not set.
6257
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006258 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006259 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6260 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006261
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006262 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006263 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006264 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006265
6266
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006267option http-no-delay
6268no option http-no-delay
6269 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | yes | yes | yes
6272 Arguments : none
6273
6274 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6275 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6276 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6277 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6278 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6279 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6280 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6281 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6282 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6283 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6284 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6285 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6286 affected.
6287
6288 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6289 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6290 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6291 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6292 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6293 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6294 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6295 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6296 latency environments.
6297
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006298 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6299
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006300
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006301option http-pretend-keepalive
6302no option http-pretend-keepalive
6303 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006305 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006306 Arguments : none
6307
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006308 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006309 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6310 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6311 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6312 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6313 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6314 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6315 consider the response complete.
6316
6317 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6318 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6319 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6320 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006321 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006322 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6323
6324 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6325 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6326 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6327 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6328 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6329 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6330 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6331
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006332 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6333 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6334 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6335 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6336 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6337 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006338
6339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6341
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006342 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006343 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006344
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006345
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006346option http-server-close
6347no option http-server-close
6348 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6350 yes | yes | yes | yes
6351 Arguments : none
6352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006353 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6354 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6355 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6356 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006357 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6358 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6359 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6360 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6361 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6362 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6363 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6364 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6365 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6366 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6367 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006368
6369 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6370 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6371 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6372 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006373 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6374 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006375
6376 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6377 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006378 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6379 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6380 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006381
6382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6384
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006385 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6386 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006387
6388
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006389option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6390no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6391 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006393 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006394 Arguments : none
6395
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006396 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6397 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6398 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6399
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006400 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6401 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6402 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6403 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006404 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006405
6406 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006407 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006408 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6409 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6410 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6411 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6412 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6413 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6414 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006415
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006416 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6417 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6418 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6419 backend.
6420
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6423
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006424 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6425 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006426
6427
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006428option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006429no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006430 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6432 yes | yes | yes | no
6433 Arguments : none
6434
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006435 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006436 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6437 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6438 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6439 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6440 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6441 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6442
6443 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6444 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006445 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6446 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6447 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006448
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006449 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6450 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6451 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6452 front of an existing proxy.
6453
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006454 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6455
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006456 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006457
6458
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006459option http-use-htx
6460no option http-use-htx
6461 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6463 yes | yes | yes | yes
6464 Arguments : none
6465
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006466 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006467 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006468 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6469 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6470 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6471 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6472 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006473
6474 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6475 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6476 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6477 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006478 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6479 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6480 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6481 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006482
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006483 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6484 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6485 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6486 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6487 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006488
6489 See also : "mode http"
6490
6491
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006492option httpchk
6493option httpchk <uri>
6494option httpchk <method> <uri>
6495option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6496 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6498 yes | no | yes | yes
6499 Arguments :
6500 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6501 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6502 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6503 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6504 ones.
6505
6506 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6507 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6508 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6509
6510 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6511 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6512 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6513 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6514 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6515
6516 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6517 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6518 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6519 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6520 the lack of any response.
6521
6522 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6523
6524 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6525 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6526 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6527
6528 Examples :
6529 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6530 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6531 backend https_relay
6532 mode tcp
6533 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6534 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6535
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006536 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6537 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6538 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006539
6540
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006541option httpclose
6542no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006543 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6545 yes | yes | yes | yes
6546 Arguments : none
6547
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006548 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6549 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6550 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6551 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006552 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006553
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006554 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6555 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6556 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6557 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6558 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006559
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006560 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6561 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6562 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006563
6564 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6565 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006566 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006567 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6568 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6569 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006570
6571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6573
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006574 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006575
6576
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006577option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006578 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006580 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006581 Arguments :
6582 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6583 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6584 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006585 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006586 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006587
6588 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6589 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6590 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6591 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6592 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6593 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6594 ports.
6595
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006596 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6597 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006598
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006599 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006601 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006602
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006603
6604option http_proxy
6605no option http_proxy
6606 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | yes | yes | yes
6609 Arguments : none
6610
6611 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6612 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6613 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6614 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6615 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6616
6617 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6618 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006619 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6620 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006621
6622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6624
6625 Example :
6626 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6627 backend direct_forward
6628 option httpclose
6629 option http_proxy
6630
6631 See also : "option httpclose"
6632
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006633
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006634option independent-streams
6635no option independent-streams
6636 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6638 yes | yes | yes | yes
6639 Arguments : none
6640
6641 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6642 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6643 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6644 receive data or not.
6645
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006646 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006647 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6648 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6649 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6650 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6651 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6652 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6653 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6654 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6655 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6656 socket buffers.
6657
6658 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6659 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6660 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6661 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6662 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6663
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006664 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006665 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6666 deprecated.
6667
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006668 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006669
6670
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006671option ldap-check
6672 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6674 yes | no | yes | yes
6675 Arguments : none
6676
6677 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6678 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6679 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6680 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6681
6682 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6683 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6684
6685 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6686 configure it.
6687
6688 Example :
6689 option ldap-check
6690
6691 See also : "option httpchk"
6692
6693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006694option external-check
6695 Use external processes for server health checks
6696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6697 yes | no | yes | yes
6698
6699 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6700 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6701 command".
6702
6703 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6704
6705 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6706
6707
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006708option log-health-checks
6709no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006710 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | no | yes | yes
6713 Arguments : none
6714
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006715 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6716 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6717 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006718
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006719 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6720 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6721 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6722 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6723 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6724
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006725 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006726 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006727
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006728 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6729 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6730 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006731
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006732
6733option log-separate-errors
6734no option log-separate-errors
6735 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6737 yes | yes | yes | no
6738 Arguments : none
6739
6740 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6741 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6742 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6743 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6744 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6745 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6746 provides very important information.
6747
6748 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6749 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6750 error logs.
6751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006752 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006753 logging.
6754
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006755
6756option logasap
6757no option logasap
6758 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6760 yes | yes | yes | no
6761 Arguments : none
6762
6763 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6764 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6765 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6766 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6767 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6768 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6769 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006770 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6772 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6773
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006774 Examples :
6775 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6776 mode http
6777 option httplog
6778 option logasap
6779 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6780
6781 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6782 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6783 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6784 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006786 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006787 logging.
6788
6789
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006790option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006791 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006794 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006795 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6796 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006797 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006798
6799 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6800 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006801 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006802 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6803 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6804 in the MySQL table, like this :
6805
6806 USE mysql;
6807 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6808 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6809
6810 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006811 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006812 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6813 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6814 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6815 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6816 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6817 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6818 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6819
6820 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6821 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006822
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006823 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006824
6825 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6826 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6827 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6828 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006829 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6830 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006831
6832 See also: "option httpchk"
6833
6834
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006835option nolinger
6836no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006837 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006840 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006841
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006842 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006843 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6844 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6845 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6846 connections.
6847
6848 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6849 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6850 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6851 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6852 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6853 this too.
6854
6855 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6856 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6857 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6858
6859 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6860 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6861 for servers.
6862
6863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6865
6866
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006867option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6868 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6870 yes | yes | yes | yes
6871 Arguments :
6872 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6873 matching <network>
6874 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6875 header name.
6876
6877 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6878 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6879 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6880 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6881 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6882 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6883 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6884 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6885 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6886 possible that the client has already brought one.
6887
6888 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6889 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6890 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6891 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6892 header and requires different one.
6893
6894 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6895 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6896 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6897 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6898 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6899 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6900 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6901
6902 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6903 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6904 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6905 both are defined.
6906
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006907 Examples :
6908 # Original Destination address
6909 frontend www
6910 mode http
6911 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6912
6913 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6914 backend www
6915 mode http
6916 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6917
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006918 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006919
6920
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006921option persist
6922no option persist
6923 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006926 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006927
6928 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6929 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6930 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6931 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6932 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6933 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6934 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6935 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6936 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6937 redirected to another valid server.
6938
6939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6941
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006942 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006943
6944
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006945option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6946 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | no | yes | yes
6949 Arguments :
6950 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6951 PostgreSQL server.
6952
6953 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6954 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6955 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6956 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6957
6958 See also: "option httpchk"
6959
6960
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006961option prefer-last-server
6962no option prefer-last-server
6963 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6965 yes | no | yes | yes
6966 Arguments : none
6967
6968 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6969 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6970 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6971 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6972 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6973 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6974 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6975 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6976 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006977 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6978 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006979 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6980 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6981 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006982 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6983 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6984 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006985
6986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6988
6989 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6990
6991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006992option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006993option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006994no option redispatch
6995 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006998 Arguments :
6999 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7000 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7001 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007003 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007004 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007005 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7006 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7007 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007009
7010 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7011 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7012 be able to access the service anymore.
7013
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007014 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7015 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007016
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007017 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007018 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7019 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007021 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7022 "redisp" keywords.
7023
7024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7026
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007027 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007028
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007029
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007030option redis-check
7031 Use redis health checks for server testing
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 yes | no | yes | yes
7034 Arguments : none
7035
7036 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7037 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7038 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7039 find the "+PONG" response message.
7040
7041 Example :
7042 option redis-check
7043
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007044 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007045
7046
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007047option smtpchk
7048option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7049 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007052 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007053 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007054 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007055 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7056
7057 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7058 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7059 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7060
7061 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7062 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7063 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7064 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7065 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7066 dead server.
7067
7068 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7069 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007070 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007071 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7072
7073 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7074 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7075 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7076 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007077 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007078
7079 Example :
7080 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7081
7082 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007085option socket-stats
7086no option socket-stats
7087
7088 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | yes | yes | no
7091
7092 Arguments : none
7093
7094
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007095option splice-auto
7096no option splice-auto
7097 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7099 yes | yes | yes | yes
7100 Arguments : none
7101
7102 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7103 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007104 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007105 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007106 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007107 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7108 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7109 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7110 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7111
7112 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7113 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7114 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7115 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7116 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7117 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7118 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7119 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7120 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7121 keyword.
7122
7123 Example :
7124 option splice-auto
7125
7126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7128
7129 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7130 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7131
7132
7133option splice-request
7134no option splice-request
7135 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | yes | yes | yes
7138 Arguments : none
7139
7140 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007141 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007142 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7143 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7144 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7145 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7146
7147 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7148
7149 Example :
7150 option splice-request
7151
7152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7154
7155 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7156 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7157
7158
7159option splice-response
7160no option splice-response
7161 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 yes | yes | yes | yes
7164 Arguments : none
7165
7166 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007167 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007168 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7169 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7170 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7171 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7172
7173 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7174
7175 Example :
7176 option splice-response
7177
7178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7180
7181 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7182 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7183
7184
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007185option spop-check
7186 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7188 no | no | no | yes
7189 Arguments : none
7190
7191 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7192 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7193 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7194 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7195
7196 Example :
7197 option spop-check
7198
7199 See also : "option httpchk"
7200
7201
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007202option srvtcpka
7203no option srvtcpka
7204 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7206 yes | no | yes | yes
7207 Arguments : none
7208
7209 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7210 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007211 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007212 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7213
7214 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7215 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7216 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7217 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7218
7219 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7220 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7221 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7222 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7223 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7224
7225 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7226
7227 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7228 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7229 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7230
7231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7233
7234 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7235
7236
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007237option ssl-hello-chk
7238 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 yes | no | yes | yes
7241 Arguments : none
7242
7243 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7244 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7245 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7246 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7247 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7248 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7249 hello message.
7250
7251 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7252 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7253 messages, which is appreciable.
7254
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007255 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7256 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7257 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007258
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007259 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7260
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007261
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007262option tcp-check
7263 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 yes | no | yes | yes
7266
7267 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7268 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7269
7270 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7271 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7272 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7273
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007274 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007275 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7276 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7277 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7278 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7279 only.
7280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007281 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007282 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7283 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7284 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7285 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7286
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007287 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007288 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7289 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007290 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7292 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7293 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7294 the respective protocols.
7295 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007296 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007297
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007298 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7299 script.
7300
7301 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7302 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7303 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7304 The "comment" is of course optional.
7305
7306
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007307 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007308 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007309 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007310 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007312 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007313 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007314 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007315
7316 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7317 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007318 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007319 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007320 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007321 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007322 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007323 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007324 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7325 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007326 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007327 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7328 tcp-check expect string +OK
7329
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007331 (send many headers before analyzing)
7332 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007333 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007334 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7335 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7336 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7337 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007338 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007339
7340
7341 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7342
7343
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007344option tcp-smart-accept
7345no option tcp-smart-accept
7346 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 yes | yes | yes | no
7349 Arguments : none
7350
7351 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7352 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7353 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7354 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7355 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7356 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7357
7358 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7359 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7360 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7361 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7362
7363 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7364 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7365 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007366 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007367
7368 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7369 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7370 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7371
7372 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7373 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7374 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7375
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007376 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7377
7378
7379option tcp-smart-connect
7380no option tcp-smart-connect
7381 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 yes | no | yes | yes
7384 Arguments : none
7385
7386 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7387 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7388 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7389 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7390 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7391
7392 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7393 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7394 complex.
7395
7396 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7397 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7398 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7399
7400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7402
7403 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7404
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007405
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007406option tcpka
7407 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | yes | yes | yes
7410 Arguments : none
7411
7412 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7413 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007414 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007415 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7416
7417 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7418 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7419 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7420 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7421
7422 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7423 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7424 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7425 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7426 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7427
7428 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7429
7430 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7431 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7432 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7433 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7434 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7435 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7436 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7437 backends.
7438
7439 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7440
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007441
7442option tcplog
7443 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007445 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007446 Arguments : none
7447
7448 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7449 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7450 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7451 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7452 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7453 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7454 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7455 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7456
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007457 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007459 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007460
7461
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007462option transparent
7463no option transparent
7464 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007466 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007467 Arguments : none
7468
7469 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7470 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7471 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7472 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7473 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7474 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7475 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7476 appropriate server.
7477
7478 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7479 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7480
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007481 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007482 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007483
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007484
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007485external-check command <command>
7486 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7488 yes | no | yes | yes
7489
7490 Arguments :
7491 <command> is the external command to run
7492
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007493 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7494
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007495 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007496
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007497 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7498 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7499 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7500 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7501 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7502 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007503
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007504 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7505
7506 Environment variables :
7507 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7508 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7509
7510 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7511
7512 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7513
7514 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7515 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7516 for a UNIX socket).
7517
7518 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7519
7520 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7521
7522 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7523
7524 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7525
7526 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7527
7528 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7529 socket).
7530
7531 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7532 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7533
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007534 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7535 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7536 failed.
7537
7538 Example :
7539 external-check command /bin/true
7540
7541 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7542
7543
7544external-check path <path>
7545 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 yes | no | yes | yes
7548
7549 Arguments :
7550 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7551
7552 The default path is "".
7553
7554 Example :
7555 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7556
7557 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7558 "external-check command"
7559
7560
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007561persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007562persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007563 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | no | yes | yes
7566 Arguments :
7567 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007568 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7569 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007570
7571 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7572 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007573 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007574 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7575 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7576 forwarded to this server.
7577
7578 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7579 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7580 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007581 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007582 a single "listen" section.
7583
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007584 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7585 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7586 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7587
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007588 Example :
7589 listen tse-farm
7590 bind :3389
7591 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7592 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7593 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7594 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7595 persist rdp-cookie
7596 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007597 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007598 balance rdp-cookie
7599 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7600 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7601
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007602 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7603 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007604
7605
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007606rate-limit sessions <rate>
7607 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7609 yes | yes | yes | no
7610 Arguments :
7611 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7612 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7613
7614 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7615 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7616 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7617 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7618 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7619 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7620
7621 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7622 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7623 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7624 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7625
7626 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7627 listen smtp
7628 mode tcp
7629 bind :25
7630 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007631 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007632
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007633 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7634 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7635 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007636
7637 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7638
7639
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007640redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7641redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7642redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007643 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 no | yes | yes | yes
7646
7647 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007648 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007649
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007650 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007651 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007652 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7653 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7654 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007655
7656 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7657 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7658 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7659 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7660 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007661 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7662 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7663 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7664 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007665
7666 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7667 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7668 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7669 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7670 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7671 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007672 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007673 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007674 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7675 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7676 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007677
7678 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007679 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7680 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7681 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007682 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007683 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7684 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7685 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7686 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007687
7688 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007689 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007690
7691 - "drop-query"
7692 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7693 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7694 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7695 with a location-type redirect.
7696
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007697 - "append-slash"
7698 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7699 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7700 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7701 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7702
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007703 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7704 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7705 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7706 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7707 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7708 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7709 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7710
7711 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7712 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7713 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7714 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7715 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7716 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7717 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007718
7719 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7720 acl clear dst_port 80
7721 acl secure dst_port 8080
7722 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007723 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007724 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007725 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7726
7727 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007728 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7729 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7730 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007731 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007732
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007733 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7734 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7735 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7736
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007737 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007738 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007739
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007740 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007741 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7742 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7743 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007745 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007746
7747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007748redisp (deprecated)
7749redispatch (deprecated)
7750 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007753 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007754
7755 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7756 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7757 be able to access the service anymore.
7758
7759 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7760 redistribute them to a working server.
7761
7762 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7763 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7764 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007766 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7767 "option redispatch" instead.
7768
7769 See also : "option redispatch"
7770
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007771
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007772reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 no | yes | yes | yes
7776 Arguments :
7777 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7778 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007779 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007780
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007781 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7782 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7783
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007784 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7785 the last header of an HTTP request.
7786
7787 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7788 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7789 responses.
7790
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007791 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7792 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7793 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7794
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007795 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7796 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007797
7798
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007799reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7800reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007801 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 no | yes | yes | yes
7804 Arguments :
7805 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7806 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7807 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7808 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7809 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7810 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7811 ignores case.
7812
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007813 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7814 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7815
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007816 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7817 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7818 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7819 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007820 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007821
7822 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7823 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7824
7825 Example :
7826 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7827 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7828 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7829
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007830 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7831 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007832
7833
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007834reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7835reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007836 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 no | yes | yes | yes
7839 Arguments :
7840 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7841 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7842 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7843 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7844 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7845 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007850 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7851 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7852 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7853 next servers.
7854
7855 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7856 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7857 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7858
7859 Example :
7860 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7861 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7862 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7863
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007864 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7865 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866
7867
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007868reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7869reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007870 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7872 no | yes | yes | yes
7873 Arguments :
7874 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7875 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7876 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7877 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7878 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7879 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7880 case.
7881
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007882 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7883 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7884
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007885 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7886 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7887 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7888 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007889 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007890
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007891 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007892 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007893 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007894
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007895 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7896 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7897
7898 Example :
7899 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7900 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7901 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7902
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007903 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7904 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007905
7906
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007907reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7908reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007909 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7911 no | yes | yes | yes
7912 Arguments :
7913 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7914 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7915 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7916 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7917 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7918 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7919 case.
7920
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007921 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7922 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7923
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007924 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7925 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7926 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7927 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7928
7929 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7930 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7931
7932 Example :
7933 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7934 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7935 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7936 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7937
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007938 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7939 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007940
7941
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007942reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7943reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007944 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 no | yes | yes | yes
7947 Arguments :
7948 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7949 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7950 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7951 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7952 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7953 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7954
7955 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7956 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7957 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7958 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007959 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007960
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007961 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7962 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7963
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007964 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7965 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7966 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7967
7968 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7969 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7970 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7971 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7972 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7973
7974 Example :
7975 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007976 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007977 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7978 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7979
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007980 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7981 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007982
7983
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007984reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7985reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007986 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 no | yes | yes | yes
7989 Arguments :
7990 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7991 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7992 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7993 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7994 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7995 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7996 ignores case.
7997
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007998 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7999 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8000
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008001 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8002 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008003 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8004 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8005 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008006 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8007 not set.
8008
8009 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8010 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8011 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8012 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8013 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8014
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008015 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008016 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008017 # block all others.
8018 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8019 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8020
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008021 # block bad guys
8022 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8023 reqitarpit . if badguys
8024
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008025 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8026 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008027
8028
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008029retries <value>
8030 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | no | yes | yes
8033 Arguments :
8034 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8035 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8036 default value is 3.
8037
8038 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8039 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8040 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8041
8042 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008043 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8044 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008045
8046 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8047 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8048
8049 See also : "option redispatch"
8050
8051
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008052retry-on [list of keywords]
8053 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 yes | no | yes | yes
8056 Arguments :
8057 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8058 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8059 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8060 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8061
8062 none never retry
8063
8064 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8065 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8066
8067 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8068 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8069 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8070 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8071 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8072 processing the request.
8073
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008074 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8075 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8076 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8077 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8078 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8079 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8080 overflow attack for example).
8081
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008082 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8083 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8084 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8085 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8086 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8087 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8088 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8089 amplify denial of service attacks.
8090
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008091 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8092 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8093 considered to be safe to retry.
8094
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008095 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8096 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8097 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8098 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8099
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008100 all-retryable-errors
8101 retry request for any error that are considered
8102 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8103 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8104 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8105
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008106 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8107 not cumulative.
8108
8109 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8110 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8111 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8112 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8113
8114 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8115 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8116 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8117 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8118 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8119 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8120 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8121 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8122 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8123 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8124 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8125 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8126
8127 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8128 should not use this directive.
8129
8130 The default is "conn-failure".
8131
8132 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8133
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008134rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008135 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8137 no | yes | yes | yes
8138 Arguments :
8139 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8140 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008141 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008142
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008143 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8144 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8145
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008146 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8147 the last header of an HTTP response.
8148
8149 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8150 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8151 responses.
8152
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008153 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8154 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008155
8156
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008157rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8158rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008159 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8161 no | yes | yes | yes
8162 Arguments :
8163 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8164 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8165 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8166 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8167 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8168 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8169 ignores case.
8170
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008171 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8172 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8173
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008174 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8175 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008176 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008177 client.
8178
8179 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8180 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8181 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8182
8183 Example :
8184 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008185 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008186
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008187 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8188 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008189
8190
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008191rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8192rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008193 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8195 no | yes | yes | yes
8196 Arguments :
8197 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8198 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8199 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8200 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8201 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8202 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8203 ignores case.
8204
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008205 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8206 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8207
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008208 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8209 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8210 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8211 case-sensitive.
8212
8213 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008214 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8215 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8216 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008217
8218 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8219 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8220
8221 Example :
8222 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8223 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8224
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008225 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8226 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008227
8228
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008229rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8230rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008231 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8233 no | yes | yes | yes
8234 Arguments :
8235 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8236 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8237 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8238 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8239 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8240 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8241 ignores case.
8242
8243 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8244 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8245 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8246 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008247 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008248
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008249 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8250 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8251
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008252 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8253 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8254 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8255
8256 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8257 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8258 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8259 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8260 are not case-sensitive.
8261
8262 Example :
8263 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8264 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8265
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008266 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8267 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008268
8269
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008270server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008271 Declare a server in a backend
8272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8273 no | no | yes | yes
8274 Arguments :
8275 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008276 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008277 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008279 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8280 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8281 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8282 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008283 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8284 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8285 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8286 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8287 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008288 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8289 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8290 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8291 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8292 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8293 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8294 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008295 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008296 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8297 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8298 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8299 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8300 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8301 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008302 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8303 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008304 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8305 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008306
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008307 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008308 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8309 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8310 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8311 adding this value to the client's port.
8312
8313 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8314 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008316
8317 Examples :
8318 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8319 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008320 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008321 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8322 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8323 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008324
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008325 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8326 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8327 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8328 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8329 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8330
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008331 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8332 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008334server-state-file-name [<file>]
8335 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8336 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8337 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8338 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8339 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8340 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8341
8342 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8343 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8344
8345 global
8346 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8347
8348 backend bk
8349 load-server-state-from-file
8350
8351 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8352 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008353
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008354server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8355 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8356 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8358 no | no | yes | yes
8359
8360 Arguments:
8361 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8362
8363 <num | range>
8364 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8365 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8366 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8367 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8368
8369 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8370
8371 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8372
8373 <params*>
8374 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8375 keyword.
8376
8377 Examples:
8378 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8379 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8380 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8381
8382 # or
8383 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8384
8385 # would be equivalent to:
8386 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8387 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8388 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8389
8390
8391
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008392source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008393source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008394source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008395 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8397 yes | no | yes | yes
8398 Arguments :
8399 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8400 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008401
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008402 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008403 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8404 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8405 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8406 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8407 supported prefixes are :
8408 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8409 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8410 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008411 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008412 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8413 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008414
8415 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8416 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008417 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8418 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8419 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008420
8421 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8422 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8423 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8424 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8425 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8426 <addr>.
8427
8428 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8429 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8430 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8431 port.
8432
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008433 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8434 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8435 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8436 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008437 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008438 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8439 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8440 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8441 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8442 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8443 HTTP header.
8444
8445 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8446 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008447 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008448 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8449 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8450 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8451 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8452 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8453 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8454 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8455
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008456 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8457 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8458 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8459 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8460 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8461 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008463 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8464 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8465 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8466 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8467
8468 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8469 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8470 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8471 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8472 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8473 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8474
8475 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8476 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8477 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8478 there are two methods :
8479
8480 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8481 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8482 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8483 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8484 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8485 of the client ranges may be used.
8486
8487 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8488 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8489 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8490 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8491 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8492 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8493 same session.
8494
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008495 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8496 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8497 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008498 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008499
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008500 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8501
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008502 Examples :
8503 backend private
8504 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8505 source 192.168.1.200
8506
8507 backend transparent_ssl1
8508 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8509 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8510
8511 backend transparent_ssl2
8512 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8513 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8514 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8515
8516 backend transparent_ssl3
8517 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8518 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8519 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8520
8521 backend transparent_smtp
8522 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8523 # with Tproxy version 4.
8524 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8525
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008526 backend transparent_http
8527 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8528 # proxy.
8529 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008531 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008532 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008534
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008535srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8536 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | no | yes | yes
8539 Arguments :
8540 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8541 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8542 as explained at the top of this document.
8543
8544 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8545 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8546 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8547 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8548 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8549 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8550 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8551
8552 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8553 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8554 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8555 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8556 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008557 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008558 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008560
8561 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8562 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8563 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8564 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8565 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8566 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8567
8568 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8569 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8570
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008571 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8572 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008573
8574
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008575stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8576 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008578 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008579
8580 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8581 matched.
8582
8583 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8584 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8585
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008586 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8587 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008588 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008589
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008590 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8591 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8592 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8593 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008594
8595 Example :
8596 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8597 backend stats_localhost
8598 stats enable
8599 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8600
8601 Example :
8602 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8603 backend stats_auth
8604 stats enable
8605 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8606 stats admin if TRUE
8607
8608 Example :
8609 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8610 userlist stats-auth
8611 group admin users admin
8612 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8613 group readonly users haproxy
8614 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8615
8616 backend stats_auth
8617 stats enable
8618 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8619 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8620 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8621 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008623 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8624 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8625 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008626
8627
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8629 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008632 Arguments :
8633 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8634
8635 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8636
8637 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8638 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8639 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8640 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8641 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8642 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8643
8644 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8645 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8646 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008647 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008648
8649 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8650 report using "stats scope".
8651
8652 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8653 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8654 unobvious parameters.
8655
8656 Example :
8657 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8658 backend public_www
8659 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8660 stats enable
8661 stats hide-version
8662 stats scope .
8663 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008665 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8666 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8667
8668 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8669 backend private_monitoring
8670 stats enable
8671 stats uri /admin?stats
8672 stats refresh 5s
8673
8674 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8675
8676
8677stats enable
8678 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008680 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008681 Arguments : none
8682
8683 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8684 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8685 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8686 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8687 - stats auth : no authentication
8688 - stats scope : no restriction
8689
8690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8692 unobvious parameters.
8693
8694 Example :
8695 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8696 backend public_www
8697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8698 stats enable
8699 stats hide-version
8700 stats scope .
8701 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8704 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8705
8706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8707 backend private_monitoring
8708 stats enable
8709 stats uri /admin?stats
8710 stats refresh 5s
8711
8712 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8713
8714
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008715stats hide-version
8716 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008719 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008720
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008721 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8722 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8723 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8724 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8725 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8726 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8730 unobvious parameters.
8731
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008732 Example :
8733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8734 backend public_www
8735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008736 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008737 stats hide-version
8738 stats scope .
8739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008743
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8745 backend private_monitoring
8746 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747 stats uri /admin?stats
8748 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008751
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008752
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008753stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8754 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8755 Access control for statistics
8756
8757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8758 no | no | yes | yes
8759
8760 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8761 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8762 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8763 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8764 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8765 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8766
8767 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8768 instance.
8769
8770 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8771 about ACL usage.
8772
8773
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008774stats realm <realm>
8775 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008777 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008778 Arguments :
8779 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8780 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8781 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8782
8783 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8784 using a backslash ('\').
8785
8786 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8787 only related to authentication.
8788
8789 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8790 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8791 unobvious parameters.
8792
8793 Example :
8794 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8795 backend public_www
8796 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8797 stats enable
8798 stats hide-version
8799 stats scope .
8800 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008802 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8803 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8804
8805 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8806 backend private_monitoring
8807 stats enable
8808 stats uri /admin?stats
8809 stats refresh 5s
8810
8811 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8812
8813
8814stats refresh <delay>
8815 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008818 Arguments :
8819 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8820 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8821 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8822 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8823 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8824 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8825
8826 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8827 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8828 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8829 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8830
8831 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8832 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8833 unobvious parameters.
8834
8835 Example :
8836 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8837 backend public_www
8838 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8839 stats enable
8840 stats hide-version
8841 stats scope .
8842 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008843 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008844 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8845 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8846
8847 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8848 backend private_monitoring
8849 stats enable
8850 stats uri /admin?stats
8851 stats refresh 5s
8852
8853 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8854
8855
8856stats scope { <name> | "." }
8857 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008860 Arguments :
8861 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8862 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8863 section in which the statement appears.
8864
8865 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8866 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8867 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8868 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8869 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8870 exists.
8871
8872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8874 unobvious parameters.
8875
8876 Example :
8877 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8878 backend public_www
8879 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8880 stats enable
8881 stats hide-version
8882 stats scope .
8883 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008884 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008885 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8886 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8887
8888 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8889 backend private_monitoring
8890 stats enable
8891 stats uri /admin?stats
8892 stats refresh 5s
8893
8894 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008897stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008898 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008900 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008902 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008903 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8904
8905 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8906 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8907
8908 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8909 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008910 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008911
8912 Example :
8913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8914 backend private_monitoring
8915 stats enable
8916 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8917 stats uri /admin?stats
8918 stats refresh 5s
8919
8920 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8921 global section.
8922
8923
8924stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008925 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8927 yes | yes | yes | yes
8928 Arguments : none
8929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008930 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8932 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8933 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8934 - IP (socket, server)
8935 - cookie (backend, server)
8936
8937 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8938 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940
8941 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8942
8943
8944stats show-node [ <name> ]
8945 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008947 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008948 Arguments:
8949 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8950 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8951
8952 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8953 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955
8956 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8957 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8958 unobvious parameters.
8959
8960 Example:
8961 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8962 backend private_monitoring
8963 stats enable
8964 stats show-node Europe-1
8965 stats uri /admin?stats
8966 stats refresh 5s
8967
8968 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8969 section.
8970
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008971
8972stats uri <prefix>
8973 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008975 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008976 Arguments :
8977 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8978 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8979 query string.
8980
8981 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8982 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8983 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8984 possible to reach it in the application.
8985
8986 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008987 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008988 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8989 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8990 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8991 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8992
8993 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8994 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8995 an address or a port to statistics only.
8996
8997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8999 unobvious parameters.
9000
9001 Example :
9002 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9003 backend public_www
9004 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9005 stats enable
9006 stats hide-version
9007 stats scope .
9008 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009009 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009010 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9011 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9012
9013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9014 backend private_monitoring
9015 stats enable
9016 stats uri /admin?stats
9017 stats refresh 5s
9018
9019 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9020
9021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009022stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9023 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009025 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009026
9027 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009028 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009029 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009031 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9032
9033 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9034 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9035 the "stick-table" statement.
9036
9037 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9038 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9039 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9040 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9041 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9042
9043 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9044 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9045 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9046 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9047 transformation rules.
9048
9049 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9050 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9051 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9052 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9053 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9054 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9055 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9056
9057 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9058 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9059 ACL based conditions.
9060
9061 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9062 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9063 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9064 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9065
9066 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9067 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9068 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9069 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9070
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009071 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9072 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009073 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009074
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009075 Example :
9076 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9077 # last 30 minutes
9078 backend pop
9079 mode tcp
9080 balance roundrobin
9081 stick store-request src
9082 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9083 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9084 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9085
9086 backend smtp
9087 mode tcp
9088 balance roundrobin
9089 stick match src table pop
9090 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9091 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9092
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009093 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009094 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009095
9096
9097stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9098 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 no | no | yes | yes
9101
9102 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9103 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9104 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9105 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9106
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009107 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9108 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009110
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009111 Examples :
9112 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009113 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009114
9115 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9116 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9117 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9118
9119
9120 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9121 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9122 backend http
9123 mode http
9124 balance roundrobin
9125 stick on src table https
9126 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9127 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9128 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9129
9130 backend https
9131 mode tcp
9132 balance roundrobin
9133 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9134 stick on src
9135 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9136 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9137
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009138 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009139
9140
9141stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9142 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9144 no | no | yes | yes
9145
9146 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009147 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009148 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009150 server is selected.
9151
9152 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9153 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9154 the "stick-table" statement.
9155
9156 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9157 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9158 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9159 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9160 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9161 address.
9162
9163 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9164 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9165 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9166 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9167 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9168 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9169 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9170 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9171 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9172 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9173
9174 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9175 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9176 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9177 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9178 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9179 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9180 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9181
9182 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9183 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9184 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9185 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9186
9187 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9188 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9189 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9190 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9191 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9192 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009193 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9194 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9195 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9196 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9197 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9198 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009199
9200 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9201 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9202 the request.
9203
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009204 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9205 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009207
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009208 Example :
9209 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9210 # last 30 minutes
9211 backend pop
9212 mode tcp
9213 balance roundrobin
9214 stick store-request src
9215 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9216 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9217 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9218
9219 backend smtp
9220 mode tcp
9221 balance roundrobin
9222 stick match src table pop
9223 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9224 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9225
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009226 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009227 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009228
9229
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009230stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009231 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9232 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009233 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009235 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009236
9237 Arguments :
9238 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9239 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9240 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9241 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9242
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009243 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9244 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9245 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9246 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9247
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009248 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9249 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9250 instance.
9251
9252 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9253 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9254 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9255 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9256 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9257 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009258 to 32 characters.
9259
9260 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9261 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9262 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009263 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009264 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9265 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009266
9267 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009268 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9269 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009270 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9271 increase.
9272
9273 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009274 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9275 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9276 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009277
9278 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9279 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9280 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9281 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009282 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009283 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9284 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9285 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9286 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9287 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9288 parameter (see below).
9289
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009290 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9291 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9292 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9293 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9294 soft restart.
9295
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009296 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9297 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009298
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009299 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9300 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9301 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9302 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009303 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009304 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009305 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9306 if not expiration delay is specified.
9307
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009308 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9309 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9310 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9311 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009312 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9313 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9314 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9315 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9316 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9317 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9318 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9319 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9320 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9321 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9322 types and their arguments.
9323
9324 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9325 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9326 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9327 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9328
9329 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9330 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9331 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009332 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009333
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009334 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9335 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9336 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009337 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009338 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009339 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009340
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009341 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9342 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9343 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9344 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9345
9346 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9347 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9348 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9349 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9350 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9351 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9352
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009353 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9354 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9355 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9356 they were received.
9357
9358 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9359 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9360 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9361 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9362 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9363
9364 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9365 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9366 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9367 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9368 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9369
9370 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9371 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9372 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9373
9374 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9375 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9376 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9377 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9378 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9379
9380 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9381 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9382 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9383 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9384 the client side.
9385
9386 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9387 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9388 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9389 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9390 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9391 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9392 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9393
9394 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9395 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9396 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9397 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9398 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9399 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009400 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009401
9402 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9403 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9404 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9405 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9406 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9407 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9408
9409 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009410 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009411 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9412 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9413
9414 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9415 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9416 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9417 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9418 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9419 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9420 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9421 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9422 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9423 recommended for better fairness.
9424
9425 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009426 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009427 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9428 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9429
9430 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9431 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9432 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9433 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9434 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9435 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9436 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9437 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9438 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9439 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009440
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009441 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9442 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009443 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9444 reference it.
9445
9446 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9447 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009448 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9449 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9450 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009451
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009452 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9453 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9454 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9455 something that can be ignored.
9456
9457 Example:
9458 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9459 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9460 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9461 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9462
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009463 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009464 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009465
9466
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009467stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009468 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9470 no | no | yes | yes
9471
9472 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009473 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009474 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009475 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009476 server is selected.
9477
9478 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9479 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9480 the "stick-table" statement.
9481
9482 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9483 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9484 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9485 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9486
9487 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9488 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9489 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9490 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9491 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9492 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009493 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009494 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9495 rules.
9496
9497 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9498 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9499 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9500 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9501 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9502 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9503 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9504
9505 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9506 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9507 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9508 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9509
9510 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9511 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9512 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9513 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9514 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9515 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009516 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9517 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9518 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9519 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9520 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9521 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9522 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9523 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9524 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009525
9526 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9527
9528 Example :
9529 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9530 backend https
9531 mode tcp
9532 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009533 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009534 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009535
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009536 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9537 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9538
9539 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9540 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9541 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9542
9543 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9544 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009545
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009546 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9547 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9548 # at offset 44.
9549
9550 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9551 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9552
9553 # Learn on response if server hello.
9554 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009555
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009556 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9557 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9558
9559 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9560 extraction.
9561
9562
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009563tcp-check connect [params*]
9564 Opens a new connection
9565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 no | no | yes | yes
9567
9568 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9569 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9570 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9571
9572 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9573 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9574 of the sequence.
9575
9576 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9577 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9578 do.
9579
9580 Parameters :
9581 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9582 use the TCP connection.
9583
9584 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9585 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9586 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9587
9588 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9589
9590 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9591
9592 Examples:
9593 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9594 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9595 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9596 option tcp-check
9597 tcp-check connect
9598 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9599 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9600 tcp-check send \r\n
9601 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9602 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9603 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9604 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9605 tcp-check send \r\n
9606 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9607 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9608
9609 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9610 option tcp-check
9611 tcp-check connect port 110
9612 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9613 tcp-check connect port 143
9614 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9615 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9616
9617 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9618
9619
9620tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9623 no | no | yes | yes
9624
9625 Arguments :
9626 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9627 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9628 binary.
9629 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9630 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9631 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9632
9633 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9634 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9635 with the usual backslash ('\').
9636 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009637 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009638 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9639 used upper or lower case.
9640
9641
9642 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9643
9644 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9645 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9646 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9647 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9648 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9649 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9650 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9651 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9652
9653 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9654 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9655 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9656 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9657 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9658 expression.
9659
9660 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9661 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9662 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9663 this exact hexadecimal string.
9664 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9665
9666 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9667 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9668 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9669 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9670 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9671 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9672 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9673 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9674 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9675 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9676 the null character.
9677
9678 Examples :
9679 # perform a POP check
9680 option tcp-check
9681 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9682
9683 # perform an IMAP check
9684 option tcp-check
9685 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9686
9687 # look for the redis master server
9688 option tcp-check
9689 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009690 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009691 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9692 tcp-check expect string role:master
9693 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9694 tcp-check expect string +OK
9695
9696
9697 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9698 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9699
9700
9701tcp-check send <data>
9702 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9704 no | no | yes | yes
9705
9706 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9707 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9708
9709 Examples :
9710 # look for the redis master server
9711 option tcp-check
9712 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9713 tcp-check expect string role:master
9714
9715 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9716 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9717
9718
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009719tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9720 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009721 tcp health check
9722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 no | no | yes | yes
9724
9725 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9726 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009727 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009728 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9729 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9730 hexadecimal string.
9731 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9732
9733 Examples :
9734 # redis check in binary
9735 option tcp-check
9736 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9737 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9738
9739
9740 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9741 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9742
9743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009744tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9745 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9747 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009748 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009749 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9750 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009751
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009752 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009753
9754 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9755 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009756 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9757 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9758 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9759 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9760 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9761 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009762
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009763 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9764 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9765 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9766 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009767
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009768 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009769 - accept :
9770 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9771 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9772 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009773
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009774 - reject :
9775 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9776 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9777 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9778 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9779 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9780 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9781 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9782 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9783 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9784 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9785 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009786 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009787
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009788 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9789 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9790 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9791 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9792 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9793 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9794 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9795 hosts.
9796
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009797 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9798 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9799 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9800 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9801 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9802 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9803 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9804 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9805
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009806 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9807 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9808 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9809 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9810 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9811 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9812 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9813 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9814 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009815 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9816 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009817
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009818 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009819 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009820 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9821 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9822 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9823 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9824 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9825 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9826 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9827 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9828 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9829 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9830 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9831 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009832
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009833 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009834 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009835 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009836 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009837 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9838 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9839 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9842 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9843 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9844 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009846 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9847 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9848 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9849 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9850 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009851 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9852 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9853 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9854 layer7 information is extracted.
9855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009856 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9857 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9858 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9859 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9860 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009861
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009862 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9863 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9864 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9865 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9866
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009867 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9868 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9869 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9870 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9871
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009872 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9873 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9874 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9875 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9876 continues.
9877
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009878 - set-src <expr> :
9879 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9880 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9881 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009882 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009884 Arguments:
9885 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9886 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009887
9888 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009889 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9890
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009891 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9892 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009893
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009894 - set-src-port <expr> :
9895 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9896 expression.
9897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009898 Arguments:
9899 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9900 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009901
9902 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009903 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9904
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009905 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9906 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9907 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009908
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009909 - set-dst <expr> :
9910 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9911 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9912 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9913 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9914 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9915
9916 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9917 followed by some converters.
9918
9919 Example:
9920
9921 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9922 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9923
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009924 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9925 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9926
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009927 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9928 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9929 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9930 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9931
9932
9933 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9934 followed by some converters.
9935
9936 Example:
9937
9938 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9939
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009940 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9941 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9942 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9943
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009944 - "silent-drop" :
9945 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009946 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009947 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9948 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9949 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9950 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9951 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009952 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9953 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009954 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9955 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009956 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009957 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9958 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9959 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9960 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009962 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9963 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9964 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009966 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9967 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9968 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009971 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009972 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009974 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9975 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9976 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009978 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009979 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9980 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009981
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009982 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9983
9984 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9985
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009986 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9987
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009988 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009989
9990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009991tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9992 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009994 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009995 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009996 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9997 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009999 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010002 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10003 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10004 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10005 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010007 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10008 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10009 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10010 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010011 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10012 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10013 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10014 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10015 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10016 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010017 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010018 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010020 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10021 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10022 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10023 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010024
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010025 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010026 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010027 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010028 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10029 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010030 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010031 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010032 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010033 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010035 - set-dst <expr>
10036 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010037 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010038 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010039 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010040 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010042 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10043 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010044 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10045 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010046
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010047 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10048 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10049 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10050 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10051 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10052 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010054 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010055 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10056 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010058 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010059 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10060 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10061 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10062 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010063 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10064 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10065 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010066
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010067 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010068 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10069 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10070 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010071
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010072 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10073 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10074
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010075 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010076 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10077 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010078
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010079 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10080 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010081 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010082 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10083 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010084 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010085 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010086 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010087 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10088 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010090 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10091 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010092
10093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10094 followed by some converters.
10095
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010096 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10097 <var-name>.
10098
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010099 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10100 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10101 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10102 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10103 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10104
10105 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10106 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10107 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10108 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10109 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10110 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10111 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10112 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10113 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10114 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10115 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10116
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010117 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10118 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10119 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10120 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10121 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10122
10123 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10124
10125 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10126
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010127 Example:
10128
10129 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010130 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010131
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010132 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010133 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10134 # and reject everything else.
10135 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10136 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010137 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010138 tcp-request content reject
10139
10140 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010141 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10142 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10143 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010144 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010145
10146 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10147 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10148 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010149 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010150 tcp-request content reject
10151
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010152 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010153 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010154 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010155 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010156 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10157 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010158
10159 Example:
10160 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10161 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010162 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010164 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010165 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010166
10167 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010168 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010169 # protecting all our sites
10170 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010171 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10172 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010173 ...
10174 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10175
10176 backend http_dynamic
10177 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010178 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010179 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010180 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010181 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010182 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010183 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010185 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010186
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010187 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10188 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189
10190
10191tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10192 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010194 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010195 Arguments :
10196 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10197 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10198 as explained at the top of this document.
10199
10200 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10201 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10202 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10203 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10204 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10205
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010206 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10207 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10208 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10209 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10210
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010211 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10212 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010213 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010214 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010215 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10216 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10217 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10218 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010219
10220 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10221 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10222 it pass through unaffected.
10223
10224 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10225 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10226 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010227 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010228 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10229 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010230 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10231 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10232 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010234 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010235 "timeout client".
10236
10237
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010238tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10239 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10241 no | no | yes | yes
10242 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010243 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10244 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010245
10246 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10247
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010248 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010249 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10250 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010251 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10252 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010253
10254 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10255
10256 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10257 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10258 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10259 inserted.
10260
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010261 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010262 - accept :
10263 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10264 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10265 the rules evaluation.
10266
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010267 - close :
10268 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10269 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10270 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10271 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10272 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10273 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010274 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010275 protocols.
10276
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010277 - reject :
10278 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10279 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010280 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010281
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010282 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10283 Sets a variable.
10284
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010285 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10286 Unsets a variable.
10287
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010288 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10289 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10290 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10291 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10292
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010293 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10294 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10295 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10296 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10297
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010298 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10299 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10300 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10301 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10302 continues.
10303
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010304 - "silent-drop" :
10305 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010306 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010307 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10308 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10309 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10310 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10311 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010312 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10313 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010314 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10315 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010316 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010317 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10318 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10319 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10320 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10321
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010322 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10323 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10324
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010325 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10326 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10327 for changing the default action to a reject.
10328
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010329 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10330 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10331 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10332 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010333 period.
10334
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010335 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10336 declared inline.
10337
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010338 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10339 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010340 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010341 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10342 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010343 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010345 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010346 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10347 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010348 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010349 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10350 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010351
10352 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10353 followed by some converters.
10354
10355 Example:
10356
10357 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10358
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010359 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10360 <var-name>.
10361
10362 Example:
10363
10364 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10365
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010366 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10367 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10368 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10369 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10370 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10371
10372 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10373
10374 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10375
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010376 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10377
10378 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10379
10380
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010381tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10382 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10384 no | yes | yes | no
10385 Arguments :
10386 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10387 below.
10388
10389 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10390
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010391 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010392 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10393 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10394 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10395 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10396 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10397 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10398 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010399 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010400 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10401 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10402 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10403 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10404 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10405 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10406 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10407 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10408 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10409 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10410 instead.
10411
10412 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10413 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10414 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10415 rules which may be inserted.
10416
10417 Several types of actions are supported :
10418 - accept : the request is accepted
10419 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10420 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10421 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010422 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010423 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10424 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010425 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010426 - silent-drop
10427
10428 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10429 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10430 sections for a complete description.
10431
10432 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10433 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10434 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10435
10436 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10437 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10438 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10439 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10440 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10441
10442 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10443 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10444
10445 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10446 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10447 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10448
10449 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10450 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10451 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10452
10453 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10454 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10455 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10456
10457 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10458 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10459 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10460
10461 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10462
10463 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10464
10465
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010466tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10467 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10469 no | no | yes | yes
10470 Arguments :
10471 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10472 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10473 as explained at the top of this document.
10474
10475 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10476
10477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010478timeout check <timeout>
10479 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10480 established.
10481
10482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10483 yes | no | yes | yes
10484 Arguments:
10485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10487 as explained at the top of this document.
10488
10489 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10490 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010492 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010493 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10494 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10495 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010496
10497 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10498 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10499
10500 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10501 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010502 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010503
10504 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10506 forget about it.
10507
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010508 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10509 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010510
10511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010512timeout client <timeout>
10513timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10514 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | yes | yes | no
10517 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10520 as explained at the top of this document.
10521
10522 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10523 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10524 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010525 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10526 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10527 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10528 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010529 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10530 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10531 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010532 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010533 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010534 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10535 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010536 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10537 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010538
10539 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10540 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10541 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10542 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10543 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10544 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10545
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010546 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010548 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10549 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10550 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10551
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010552 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10553 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010554
10555
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010556timeout client-fin <timeout>
10557 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10559 yes | yes | yes | no
10560 Arguments :
10561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10563 as explained at the top of this document.
10564
10565 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10566 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10567 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10568 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10569 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10570 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10571 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010572 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10573 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10574 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010575
10576 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10577 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10578 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10579
10580 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10581
10582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010583timeout connect <timeout>
10584timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10585 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10587 yes | no | yes | yes
10588 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010589 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010590 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10591 as explained at the top of this document.
10592
10593 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010594 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010595 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010596 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010597 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10598 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010599
10600 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10601 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10602 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10603 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10604 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10605 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10606
10607 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10608 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10609 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10610
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010611 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10612 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010613
10614
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010615timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10616 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10618 yes | yes | yes | yes
10619 Arguments :
10620 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10622 as explained at the top of this document.
10623
10624 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10625 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10626 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10627 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10628 once the request has started to present itself.
10629
10630 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10631 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10632 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10633 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10634 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10635
10636 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10637 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10638 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10639 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10640
10641 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10642 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010643 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010644 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10645 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010646 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010647
10648 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10649 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10650 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10651 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10652
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010653 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10654 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010655 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10656
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010657 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10658
10659
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010660timeout http-request <timeout>
10661 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010663 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010664 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10667 as explained at the top of this document.
10668
10669 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10670 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10671 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10672 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10673 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10674 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10675 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010676 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10677 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10678 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10679 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010680 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010681 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10682 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010683
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010684 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10685 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10686 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10687 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10688 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010689 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010690
10691 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10692 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010693 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010694 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10695 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10696
10697 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010698 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10699 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10700 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010701
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010702 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010703 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010704
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010705
10706timeout queue <timeout>
10707 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10709 yes | no | yes | yes
10710 Arguments :
10711 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10712 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10713 as explained at the top of this document.
10714
10715 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10716 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10717 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10718 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10719 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10720
10721 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10722 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10723 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10724 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10725
10726 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10727
10728
10729timeout server <timeout>
10730timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10731 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10733 yes | no | yes | yes
10734 Arguments :
10735 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10736 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10737 as explained at the top of this document.
10738
10739 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10740 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10741 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10742 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10743 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10744 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10745 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10746
10747 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10748 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10749 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10750 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10751 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010752 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010753 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010754 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10755 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010756 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10757 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010758
10759 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10760 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10761 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10762 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10763 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10764 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10765
10766 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10767 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10768 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10769
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010770 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010771
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010772
10773timeout server-fin <timeout>
10774 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10776 yes | no | yes | yes
10777 Arguments :
10778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10780 as explained at the top of this document.
10781
10782 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10783 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10784 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10785 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10786 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10787 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10788 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10789 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10790 situations, it should not be needed.
10791
10792 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10793 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10794 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10795
10796 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10797
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010798
10799timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010800 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10802 yes | yes | yes | yes
10803 Arguments :
10804 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10806 as explained at the top of this document.
10807
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010808 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10809 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10810 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10811 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010812
10813 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10814 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10815 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10816 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010817 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010818
10819 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10820
10821
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010822timeout tunnel <timeout>
10823 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10825 yes | no | yes | yes
10826 Arguments :
10827 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10829 as explained at the top of this document.
10830
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010831 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010832 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10833 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10834 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10836 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010837 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10838 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10839 specified.
10840
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010841 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10842 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10843 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10844 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10845 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10846 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10847 state.
10848
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010849 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10850 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10851 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10852 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010853 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010854
10855 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10856 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10857 forget about it.
10858
10859 Example :
10860 defaults http
10861 option http-server-close
10862 timeout connect 5s
10863 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010864 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010865 timeout server 30s
10866 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10867
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010868 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010869
10870
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010871transparent (deprecated)
10872 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010874 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010875 Arguments : none
10876
10877 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10878 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10879 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10880 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10881 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10882 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10883 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10884 appropriate server.
10885
10886 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10887
10888 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10889 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10890
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010891 See also: "option transparent"
10892
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010893unique-id-format <string>
10894 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10896 yes | yes | yes | no
10897 Arguments :
10898 <string> is a log-format string.
10899
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010900 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10901 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10902 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10903 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010904
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010905 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10906 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10907 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10908 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10909 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10910 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10911 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10912 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010913
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010914 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10915 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010916
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010917 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010918
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010919 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010920
10921 will generate:
10922
10923 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10924
10925 See also: "unique-id-header"
10926
10927unique-id-header <name>
10928 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10930 yes | yes | yes | no
10931 Arguments :
10932 <name> is the name of the header.
10933
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010934 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10935 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010936
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010937 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010938
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010939 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010940 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10941
10942 will generate:
10943
10944 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10945
10946 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010947
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010948use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010949 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10951 no | yes | yes | no
10952 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010953 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10954 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010955
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010956 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10957 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010958
10959 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10960 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10961 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010962 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010963 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010964 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10965 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010966
10967 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10968 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10969 assign the backend.
10970
10971 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10972 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10973 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10974 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10975 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10976 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10977
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010978 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010979 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010980 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10981 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10982 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10983
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010984 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10985 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10986 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10987 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10988 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10989 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10990 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10991 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10992 cannot be forced from the request.
10993
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010994 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010995 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10996 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10997
10998 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10999 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011000
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011001
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011002use-server <server> if <condition>
11003use-server <server> unless <condition>
11004 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11006 no | no | yes | yes
11007 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011008 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011009
11010 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11011
11012 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11013 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11014 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11015
11016 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11017 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11018 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11019 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11020 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11021 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11022 matches will assign the server.
11023
11024 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11025 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11026 with the next rules until one matches.
11027
11028 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11029 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11030 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11031 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11032
11033 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11034 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11035 stripped.
11036
11037 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11038 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11039 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11040 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11041
11042 Example :
11043 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11044 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11045 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11046 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11047 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11048 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011049 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011050 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11051 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11052
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011053 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011054
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011055
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110565. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011057--------------------------
11058
11059The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11060depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11061settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11062written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11063described in this section.
11064
11065
110665.1. Bind options
11067-----------------
11068
11069The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11070as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11071no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11072parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11073while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11074provided immediately after the setting name.
11075
11076The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11077
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011078accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11079 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11080 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11081 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11082 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11083 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11084 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11085 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11086 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11087 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011088 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11089 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11090 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011091
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011092accept-proxy
11093 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011094 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11095 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011096 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11097 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11098 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11099 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011100 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011101 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11102 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011103 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11104 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011105
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011106allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011107 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011108 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11109 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11110 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11111 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011112
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011113alpn <protocols>
11114 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11115 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11116 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11117 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11118 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011119 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11120 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11121 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11122 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11123 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11124 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11125 preference, like below :
11126
11127 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011129backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011130 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011131 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11132
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011133curves <curves>
11134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11135 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11136 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11137 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11138 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11139 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11140
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011141ecdhe <named curve>
11142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011143 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11144 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011145
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011146ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11148 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11149 client's certificate.
11150
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011151ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11153 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11154 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11155 error is ignored.
11156
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011157ca-sign-file <cafile>
11158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11159 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11160 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11161 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11162 'generate-certificates' for details.
11163
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011164ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11166 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11167 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11168 'generate-certificates' for details.
11169
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011170ciphers <ciphers>
11171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11172 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011173 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011174 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011175 information and recommendations see e.g.
11176 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11177 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11178 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11179
11180ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11182 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11183 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11184 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011185 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11186 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011187
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011188crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11190 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11191 to verify client's certificate.
11192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011193crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11195 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11196 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11197 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11198 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11199 file.
11200
11201 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11202 are loaded.
11203
11204 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011205 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011206 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11207 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11208 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11209 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11211 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011212 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011213
11214 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11215 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11216 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11217 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011218 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11219 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011220
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011221 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011223 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011224 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011225 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11226 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011227 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11228 clients).
11229
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011230 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11231 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11232 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11233 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11234 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11235 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11236 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11237 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11238 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11239 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11240 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11241 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11242 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11243
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011244 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11245 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11246 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11247 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11248 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11249
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011250 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11251 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11252 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11253 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011254
11255 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11256 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11257 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11258 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11259 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11260 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11261 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11262 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11263 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11264
11265 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11266
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011267 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011268 a cert bundle.
11269
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011270 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011271 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11272 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11273 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11274 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11275 provide multi-cert support.
11276
11277 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11278
11279 Filename | CN | SAN
11280 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11281 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011282 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011283 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11284 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11285
11286 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11287 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11288 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11289 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011290 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11291 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11292 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011293
11294 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11295 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11296
11297 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11298 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11299 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11300
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011301crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011303 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011304 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011305 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011306
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011307crt-list <file>
11308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011309 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11310 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011311
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011312 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11313
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011314 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11315 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011316 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011317 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011318
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011319 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11320 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11321 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11322 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11323 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11324 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11325 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11326 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011327
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011328 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011329 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011330 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11331 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11332 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011333
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011334 crt-list file example:
11335 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011336 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011337 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011338 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011339
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011340defer-accept
11341 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11342 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11343 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011344 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011345 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11346 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11347 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11348 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11349 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11350 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11351 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11352
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011353expose-fd listeners
11354 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11355 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011356 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11357 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011359
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011360force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011361 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011362 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011363 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011364 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011365
11366force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011367 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011368 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011369 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011370
11371force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011372 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011373 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011374 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011375
11376force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011377 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011378 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011379 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011380
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011381force-tlsv13
11382 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11383 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011384 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011385
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011386generate-certificates
11387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11388 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11389 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11390 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11391 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11392 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11393 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11394 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11395 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11396 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11397 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11398
11399 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11400 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011401 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011402 certificate is used many times.
11403
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011404gid <gid>
11405 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11406 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11407 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11408 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11409 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11410
11411group <group>
11412 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11413 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11414 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11415 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11416 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11417
11418id <id>
11419 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11420 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11421 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11422 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11423
11424interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011425 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11426 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11427 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11428 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11429 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11430 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011431 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11432 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11433 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11434 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11435 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11436 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011437
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011438level <level>
11439 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11440 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11441 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011442 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011443 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11444 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11445 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011446 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011447 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011448 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011449 all counters).
11450
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011451severity-output <format>
11452 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11453 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11454 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11455 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11456 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11457 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11458 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11459 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11460 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11461 rfc5424 convention.
11462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011463maxconn <maxconn>
11464 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11465 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11466 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11467 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11468 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11469 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11470 eat all memory.
11471
11472mode <mode>
11473 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11474 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11475 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11476 UNIX sockets.
11477
11478mss <maxseg>
11479 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11480 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11481 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11482 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11483 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11484 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11485 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11486 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11487 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11488 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11489 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11490
11491name <name>
11492 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11493 page.
11494
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011495namespace <name>
11496 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11497 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11498 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11499 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011501nice <nice>
11502 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11503 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11504 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11505 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11506 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11507 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11508 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11509 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11510 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11511 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11512 one for an RDP socket.
11513
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011514no-ca-names
11515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11516 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11517
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011518no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011520 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011521 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011522 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011523 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11524 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011525
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011526no-tls-tickets
11527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11528 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11529 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011530 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11531 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011532
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011533no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011535 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011536 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011537 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011538 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11539 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011541no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011543 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011544 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011545 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011546 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11547 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011549no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011551 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011552 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011553 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011554 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11555 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011556
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011557no-tlsv13
11558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11559 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11560 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11561 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011562 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11563 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011564
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011565npn <protocols>
11566 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11567 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11568 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11569 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011570 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011571 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11572 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11573 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11574 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11575 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011576
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011577prefer-client-ciphers
11578 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11579 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11580 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011581 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11582 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11583 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011584
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011585process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011586 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011587 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011588 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011589 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11590 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11591 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11592 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011593 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011594 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11595 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11596 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11597 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11598 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011599
11600 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11601
11602 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11603 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11604 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11605 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11606 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11607 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11608 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11609 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011610
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011611proto <name>
11612 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11613 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11614 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11615 in haproxy -vv.
11616 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11617 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011618 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011619 h2" on the bind line.
11620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011621ssl
11622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011623 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011624 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11625 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011626 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11627 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011628
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011629ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11630 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11631 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11632 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11633
11634ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11635 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11636 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11637 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11638
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011639strict-sni
11640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11641 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11642 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11643 See the "crt" option for more information.
11644
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011645tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011646 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011647 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11648 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011650 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11651 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11652 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11653 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11654 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11655 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11656 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11657
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011658tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011659 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011660 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11661 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11662 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11663 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11664 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11665 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11666 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011667 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11668 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11669 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011670
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011671tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11672 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011673 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11674 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11675 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11676 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11677 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11678 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11679 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11680 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11681 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11682 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011683 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11684 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011686transparent
11687 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11688 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11689 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11690 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11691 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11692 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11693 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11694 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11695 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11696 so check for support with your vendor.
11697
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011698v4v6
11699 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11700 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11701 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11702 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011703 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011704
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011705v6only
11706 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11707 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11708 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011709 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11710 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011711
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011712uid <uid>
11713 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11714 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11715 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11716 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11717 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11718
11719user <user>
11720 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11721 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11722 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11723 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11724 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11725
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011726verify [none|optional|required]
11727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11728 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11729 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11730 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11731 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011732 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11733 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11734 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11735 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011736
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117375.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011738------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011740The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11741which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11742arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11743settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11744after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11745Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11746address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011748 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011749 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011750
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011751Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11752keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011754The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011755
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011756addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011757 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011758 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11759 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11760 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11761 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11762 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011763
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011764agent-check
11765 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011766 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011767 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11768 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11769 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011770
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011771 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011772 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011773 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11774 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11775 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011777 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11778 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11779 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11780 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11781 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011782
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011783 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011784 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011785
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011786 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11787 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11788 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011789
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011790 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11791 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11792 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011793
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011794 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11795 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11796 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11797 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11798 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011799 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011800 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011801
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011802 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11803 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011804
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011805 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11806 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11807 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11808 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11809 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11810 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11811 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11812 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11813 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011814
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011815 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11816 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011817 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11818 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11819 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011820 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011821
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011822 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011823 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011824
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011825agent-send <string>
11826 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11827 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11828 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11829 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11830 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11831
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011832agent-inter <delay>
11833 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11834 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11835
11836 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11837 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11838 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11839 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11840 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11841 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11842 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11843 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11844 of backends use the same servers.
11845
11846 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11847
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011848agent-addr <addr>
11849 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11850
11851 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11852 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11853 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11854 hostname, it will be resolved.
11855
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011856agent-port <port>
11857 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11858
11859 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11860
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011861allow-0rtt
11862 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011863 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11864 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011865
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011866alpn <protocols>
11867 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11868 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11869 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11870 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11871 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11872 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11873 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11874 now obsolete NPN extension.
11875 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11876 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11877
11878 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011880backup
11881 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11882 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11883 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11884 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011885 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11886 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011887
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011888ca-file <cafile>
11889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11890 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11891 server's certificate.
11892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011893check
11894 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011895 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11896 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11897 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11898 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11899 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11900 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11901 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011902 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11903 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011904 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11905 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011906
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011907check-send-proxy
11908 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11909 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11910 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11911 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11912 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11913 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11914 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11915
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011916check-alpn <protocols>
11917 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11918 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11919 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11920
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011921check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011922 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011923 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11924 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011925
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011926check-ssl
11927 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11928 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11929 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11930 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011931 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011932 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11933 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011934 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011935 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11936 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011937
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011938check-via-socks4
11939 This option enables outgoinng health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
11940 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11941 for normal traffic.
11942
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011943ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11945 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11946 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011947 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11948 information and recommendations see e.g.
11949 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11950 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11951 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011952
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011953ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11955 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11956 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11957 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011958 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11959 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11960 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011962cookie <value>
11963 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11964 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11965 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11966 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11967 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11968 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11969 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11970
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011971crl-file <crlfile>
11972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11973 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11974 to verify server's certificate.
11975
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011976crt <cert>
11977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11978 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11979 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11980 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11981 certificate request.
11982
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011983disabled
11984 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11985 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11986 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11987 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11988 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011989 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011990
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011991enabled
11992 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11993 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11994 default value.
11995 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11996 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011998error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011999 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12000 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12001 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012003 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012005fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012006 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12007 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12008 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12009
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012010force-sslv3
12011 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12012 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012013 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012014 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012015
12016force-tlsv10
12017 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012018 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012019 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012020
12021force-tlsv11
12022 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012023 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012024 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012025
12026force-tlsv12
12027 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012028 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012029 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012030
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012031force-tlsv13
12032 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12033 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012034 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012036id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012037 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12038 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12039 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012041init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12042 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12043 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012044 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012045 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12046 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12047 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12048 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12049 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12050 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12051 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12052 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12053 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012054 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012055 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12056 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12057 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12058 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12059 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12060 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012061 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012062
12063 Example:
12064 defaults
12065 # never fail on address resolution
12066 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012068inter <delay>
12069fastinter <delay>
12070downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012071 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12072 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12073 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12074 between checks depending on the server state :
12075
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012076 Server state | Interval used
12077 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12078 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12079 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12080 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12081 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12082 or yet unchecked. |
12083 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12084 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12085 | "inter" otherwise.
12086 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012088 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12089 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12090 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12091 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012092 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12093 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12094 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12095 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12096 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012098maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012099 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12100 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12101 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12102 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12103 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12104 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12105 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12106 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012108maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12110 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12111 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12112 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12113 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12114 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12115 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12116
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012117max-reuse <count>
12118 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12119 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12120 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12121 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12122 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12123 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12124 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12125 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012127minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012128 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12129 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12130 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12131 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12132 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12133 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012134 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012135 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012136
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012137namespace <name>
12138 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12139 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12140 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12141 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12142
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012143no-agent-check
12144 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12145 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12146 default value.
12147 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12148 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12149
12150no-backup
12151 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12152 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12153 default value.
12154 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12155 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12156
12157no-check
12158 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12159 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12160 default value.
12161 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12162 "default-server" "check" setting.
12163
12164no-check-ssl
12165 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12166 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12167 default value.
12168 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12169 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12170
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012171no-send-proxy
12172 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12173 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12174 default value.
12175 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12176 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12177
12178no-send-proxy-v2
12179 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12180 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12181 default value.
12182 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12183 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12184
12185no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12186 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12187 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12188 default value.
12189 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12190 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12191
12192no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12193 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12194 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12195 default value.
12196 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12197 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12198
12199no-ssl
12200 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12201 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12202 default value.
12203 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12204 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12205
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012206no-ssl-reuse
12207 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12208 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12209 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12210 and for paranoid users.
12211
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012212no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012213 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12214 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012215 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012216
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012217 Supported in default-server: No
12218
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012219no-tls-tickets
12220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12221 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12222 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012223 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12224 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012225 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012226
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012227no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012228 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012229 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12230 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012231 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12232 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012233 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012234
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012235 Supported in default-server: No
12236
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012237no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012238 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012239 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12240 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012241 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12242 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012243 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012244
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012245 Supported in default-server: No
12246
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012247no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012248 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012249 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12250 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012251 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12252 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012253 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012254
12255 Supported in default-server: No
12256
12257no-tlsv13
12258 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12259 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12260 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12261 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12262 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012263 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012264
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012265 Supported in default-server: No
12266
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012267no-verifyhost
12268 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12269 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12270 default value.
12271 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12272 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012273
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012274non-stick
12275 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12276 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12277 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12278
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012279npn <protocols>
12280 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12281 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12282 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12283 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12284 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12285 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12286 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012288observe <mode>
12289 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12290 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12291 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12292 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12293 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12294 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012295 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012296
12297 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012299on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012300 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12301 Currently, four modes are available:
12302 - fastinter: force fastinter
12303 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12304 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12305 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12306 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12307
12308 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12309
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012310on-marked-down <action>
12311 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12312 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012313 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12314 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12315 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12316 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12317 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12318 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12319 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12320 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012321
12322 Actions are disabled by default
12323
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012324on-marked-up <action>
12325 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12326 Currently one action is available:
12327 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12328 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12329 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12330 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012331 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12332 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012333 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12334 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12335
12336 Actions are disabled by default
12337
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012338pool-max-conn <max>
12339 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12340 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12341 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12342 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12343 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12344 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12345
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012346pool-purge-delay <delay>
12347 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012348 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012349 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012351port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012352 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12353 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12354 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12355 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12356 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12357 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12358
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012359proto <name>
12360
12361 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12362 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12363 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12364 reported in haproxy -vv.
12365 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12366 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012368redir <prefix>
12369 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12370 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12371 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12372 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12373 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12374 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12375 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12376 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012377 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012378 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012379 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12380 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12381 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12382 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12383
12384 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012386rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012387 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12388 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12389 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12390
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012391resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12392 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12393 server.
12394
12395 Available options:
12396
12397 * allow-dup-ip
12398 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12399 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12400 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12401 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12402 For such case, simply enable this option.
12403 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12404
12405 * prevent-dup-ip
12406 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12407 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12408 same fqdn.
12409 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12410
12411 Example:
12412 backend b_myapp
12413 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12414 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12415 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12416
12417 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12418 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12419 it
12420 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12421 different address
12422
12423 Default value: not set
12424
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012425resolve-prefer <family>
12426 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12427 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12428 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12429 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12430
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012431 Default value: ipv6
12432
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012433 Example:
12434
12435 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012437resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12438 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12439 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012440 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012441 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12442 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012443 configured network, another address is selected.
12444
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012445 Example:
12446
12447 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012448
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012449resolvers <id>
12450 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12451 hostname.
12452
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012453 Example:
12454
12455 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012456
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012457 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012458
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012459send-proxy
12460 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12461 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12462 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12463 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012464 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12465 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12466 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12467 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12468 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12469 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12470 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12471 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12472 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12473 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012474 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12475 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012476
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012477send-proxy-v2
12478 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12479 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12480 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12481 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012482 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12483 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12484 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12485 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012486
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012487proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12488 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12489 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012490 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12491 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012492 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12493 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012494 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012495
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012496send-proxy-v2-ssl
12497 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12498 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12499 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12500 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12501 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12502 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12503 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012504 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12505 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012506
12507send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12508 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12509 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12510 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12511 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12512 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12513 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12514 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12515 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012516 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12517 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012519slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12521 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12522 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12523 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12524 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12525 parameters :
12526
12527 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12528 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12529
12530 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12531 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12532 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12533 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12534
12535 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12536 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12537 seen as failed.
12538
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012539sni <expression>
12540 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12541 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12542 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12543 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012544 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12545 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012546 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012547 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12548 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012549
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012550source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012551source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012552source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012553 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12554 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12555 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12556 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12557
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012558 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12559 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12560 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12561 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12562 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12563 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12564 server.
12565
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012566 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12567 specifying the source address without port(s).
12568
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012569ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012570 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12571 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12572 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12573 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12574 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12575 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012576 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12577 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012578
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012579ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12580 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12581 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12582 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12583
12584ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12585 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12586 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12587 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12588
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012589ssl-reuse
12590 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12591 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12592 default value.
12593 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12594 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12595
12596stick
12597 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12598 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12599 default value.
12600 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12601 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012602
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012603socks4 <addr>:<port>
12604 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoinng connections to the
12605 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12606 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12607
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012608tcp-ut <delay>
12609 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12610 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12611 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012612 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012613 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12614 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12615 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12616 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12617 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12618 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12619 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12620 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12621 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12622
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012623tfo
12624 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12625 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12626 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12627 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12628 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12629 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012631track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012632 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12633 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12634 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12635 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012636 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12637
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012638tls-tickets
12639 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12640 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12641 default value.
12642 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12643 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012644
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012645verify [none|required]
12646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012647 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012648 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12649 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012650 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012651 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12652 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12653 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12654 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12655 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12656 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12657 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12658 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012659
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012660verifyhost <hostname>
12661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012662 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12663 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12664 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12665 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12666 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12667 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12668 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12669 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012671weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012672 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12673 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12674 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012675 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12676 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12677 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12678 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12679 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12680 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012681
12682
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126835.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12684-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012685
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012686HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12687using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12688configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012689This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12690can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12691workload.
12692This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12693resolution at run time.
12694Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12695carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12696
12697
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126985.3.1. Global overview
12699----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012700
12701As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12702different steps of the process life:
12703
12704 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12705 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12706 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12707
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012708 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12709 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012710
12711A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12712 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12713 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12714 resolution to know this new IP.
12715
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012716When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012718SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12719from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12720will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12721will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012722
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012723A few things important to notice:
12724 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12725 first valid response.
12726
12727 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12728 servers return an error.
12729
12730
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127315.3.2. The resolvers section
12732----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012733
12734This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012735HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12736contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012737
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012738When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12739uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12740is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12741answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12742
12743When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012744used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012745
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012746 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12747 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12748 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012749
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012750 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12751 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012752
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012753 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12754 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12755 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012756
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012757For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12758following scenarios are possible:
12759
12760 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12761 ignored
12762
12763 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12764 applied
12765
12766 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12767 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12768
12769 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12770 retries the query with a new type
12771
12772 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12773 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012774
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012775As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12776a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012777<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012778
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012779
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012780resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012781 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012782
12783A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12784
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012785accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012786 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012787 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012788 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12789 by RFC 6891)
12790
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012791 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12792
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012793nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12794 DNS server description:
12795 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12796 <ip> : IP address of the server
12797 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12798
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012799parse-resolv-conf
12800 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12801 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12802 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12803
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012804hold <status> <period>
12805 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12806 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012807 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012808 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012809 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12810 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12811 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12812
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012813 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012814
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012815resolve_retries <nb>
12816 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12817 giving up.
12818 Default value: 3
12819
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012820 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12821 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12822 type.
12823
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012824timeout <event> <time>
12825 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12826 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12827 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012828 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12829 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012830 Default value: 1s
12831 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012832 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012833 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012834 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12835 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12836
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012837 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012838
12839 resolvers mydns
12840 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12841 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012842 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012843 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012844 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012845 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012846 hold other 30s
12847 hold refused 30s
12848 hold nx 30s
12849 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012850 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012851 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012852
12853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128546. HTTP header manipulation
12855---------------------------
12856
12857In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12858response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12859request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12860which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012861against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012862
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012863If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12864to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12865but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12866HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12867stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12868because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12869a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12870still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012872This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12873in section 4.2 :
12874
12875 - reqadd <string>
12876 - reqallow <search>
12877 - reqiallow <search>
12878 - reqdel <search>
12879 - reqidel <search>
12880 - reqdeny <search>
12881 - reqideny <search>
12882 - reqpass <search>
12883 - reqipass <search>
12884 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12885 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12886 - reqtarpit <search>
12887 - reqitarpit <search>
12888 - rspadd <string>
12889 - rspdel <search>
12890 - rspidel <search>
12891 - rspdeny <search>
12892 - rspideny <search>
12893 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12894 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12895
12896With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12897is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12898parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12899prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12900Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12901
12902 \t for a tab
12903 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12904 \n for a new line (LF)
12905 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12906 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12907 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12908 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12909 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12910
12911The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12912portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12913above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12914regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
129159 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12916is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12917
12918The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12919after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12920
12921Notes related to these keywords :
12922---------------------------------
12923 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12924 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12925 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12926
12927 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12928 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12929 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12930
12931 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12932 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12933 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12934 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12935 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12936
12937 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12938 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12939 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12940 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12941 useless headers before adding new ones.
12942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012943 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012944 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12945
12946 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12947 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12948 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12949
12950 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12951 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012952 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953
12954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129557. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12956----------------------------------
12957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012958HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12960The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12961these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12962but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12963data called patterns.
12964
12965
129667.1. ACL basics
12967---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012968
12969The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12970content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12971from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12972simple :
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012975 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12977 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12980adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012981
12982In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012985
12986This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12987Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12988and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012989an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12990conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12991as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12992are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012993
12994ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12995'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12996which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12997
12998There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12999performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13002specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13003this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013004methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13005ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006
13007Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13008 - boolean
13009 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13010 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13011 - string
13012 - data block
13013
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013014Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13015converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13016would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13017The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13018which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13019
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013020Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13021keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13022fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13023which are summarized in the table below :
13024
13025 +---------------------+-----------------+
13026 | Sample or converter | Default |
13027 | output type | matching method |
13028 +---------------------+-----------------+
13029 | boolean | bool |
13030 +---------------------+-----------------+
13031 | integer | int |
13032 +---------------------+-----------------+
13033 | ip | ip |
13034 +---------------------+-----------------+
13035 | string | str |
13036 +---------------------+-----------------+
13037 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13038 +---------------------+-----------------+
13039
13040Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13041matching method, see below.
13042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13044 - boolean
13045 - integer or integer range
13046 - IP address / network
13047 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13048 - regular expression
13049 - hex block
13050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013051The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13052
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013053 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13054 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013055 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013056 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013057 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013058 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013059 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013061The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13062read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13063if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13064lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13065will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13066beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13067a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13068lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13069exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13070
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013071The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13072parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13073ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13074a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13075check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13076
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013077The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13078socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13079file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13082loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13083
13084 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13085
13086In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13087the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13088case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13089as well.
13090
13091The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13092sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13093do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13094methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13095is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013096obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13098default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13099that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13100string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13101
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013102The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13103By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13104string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13105resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13106server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13107waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13108flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13109function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013111There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13112sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13113be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013114
13115 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13116 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13118 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13119 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13120 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013121
13122 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13123 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013125
13126 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013127 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013128
13129 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013130 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013132 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013133 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13134
13135 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13136 binary or string samples.
13137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13139 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13142 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13143 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13146 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13149 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13152 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013154 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13155 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013156 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13159 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13160 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013161
13162For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13163request, it is possible to do :
13164
13165 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13166
13167In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13168buffer, one would use the following acl :
13169
13170 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13171
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013172On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13173possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13174
13175 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13178criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13179method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13180to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13181criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13182the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013184If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013185the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13186For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013188 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13189 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13190 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13191 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013192
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013193
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013194The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13195types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13196combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13197brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13198default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200 +-------------------------------------------------+
13201 | Input sample type |
13202 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013203 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13205 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13206 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013207 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013209 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013211 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013213 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013215 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013217 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013219 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013221 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013222 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013223 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013224 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013225 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013227 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13229 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13230 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013231
13232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132337.1.1. Matching booleans
13234------------------------
13235
13236In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13237Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13238When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13239that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13240
13241Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13242return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13243"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132467.1.2. Matching integers
13247------------------------
13248
13249Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13250enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13251to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13252
13253Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13254matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13255lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013256
13257For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13258unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13259representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13260
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013261As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13262two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13263instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13264ranges and operators.
13265
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013266For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013267operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13268Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13269of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013271Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013272
13273 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13274 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13275 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13276 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13277 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013279For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013280
13281 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13282
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013283This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13284
13285 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13286
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132887.1.3. Matching strings
13289-----------------------
13290
13291String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13292different forms :
13293
13294 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013295 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296
13297 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013298 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013299
13300 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13301 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13302
13303 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13304 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13305
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013306 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13308 matches.
13309
13310 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13311 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13312 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013313
13314String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13315exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13316characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13317string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13318to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013319before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013320
13321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133227.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13323---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013324
13325Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13326they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13327possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13328passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13329the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013330the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13331match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013332
13333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133347.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13335-------------------------------------
13336
13337It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13338not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13339a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13340to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13341digits may be used upper or lower case.
13342
13343Example :
13344 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13345 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13346
13347
133487.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13349---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013350
13351IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13352netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13353within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013354host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013355difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13356at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13357does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13358parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013359
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013360The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13361abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13362
13363 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13364 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13365 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13366 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13367 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13368 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13369 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13370 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13371
13372Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13373192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13374
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013375IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13376Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13377trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13378IPv6 patterns.
13379
13380HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13381following situations :
13382 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13383 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13384 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13385 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13386 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13387 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13388 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13389 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13390 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13391 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393
133947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13395----------------------------------
13396
13397Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13398combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13399
13400 - AND (implicit)
13401 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13402 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013406 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013408Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13409indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13412"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13413requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13414is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13415
13416 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013417 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13418 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13419 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420
13421To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13422and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13423
13424 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13425 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13426 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13427 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13428
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013429 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13431 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13432 use_backend www if host_www
13433
13434It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13435expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13436be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13437the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13438
13439 The following rule :
13440
13441 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013442 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443
13444 Can also be written that way :
13445
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013446 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447
13448It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13449to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13450simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13451sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13452good use is the following :
13453
13454 With named ACLs :
13455
13456 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13457 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13458 monitor fail if site_dead
13459
13460 With anonymous ACLs :
13461
13462 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13463
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013464See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13465keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466
13467
134687.3. Fetching samples
13469---------------------
13470
13471Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13472against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13473sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13474ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13475of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13476available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13477
13478This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13479Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13480compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13481deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13482
13483The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13484matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13485method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13486indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13487
13488As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13489when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13490mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13491the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13492ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13493
13494Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13495multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13496when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13498are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13500all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13501
13502Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13503 - name
13504 - name(arg1)
13505 - name(arg1,arg2)
13506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013507
135087.3.1. Converters
13509-----------------
13510
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013511Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13512of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13513is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13514was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013515has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013516unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13517
13518These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13519sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13520the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013521support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013522
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013523A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13524support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13525supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13526(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13527bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013530
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001353151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13532 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13533 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13534 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13535 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13536 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13537
13538 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13540 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013541 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13542 frontend http-in
13543 bind *:8081
13544 default_backend servers
13545 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13546 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13547
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013548add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013549 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013550 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013551 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13552 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013553 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013554 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13555 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13556 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13557 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013558 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013559 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013560
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013561aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13562 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13563 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13564 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13565 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13566 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13567 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13568
13569 Example:
13570 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13571 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13572
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013573and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013574 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013575 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013576 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13577 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013578 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013579 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13580 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13581 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13582 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013584 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013585
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013586b64dec
13587 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13588 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13589
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013590base64
13591 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013592 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013593 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13594
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013595bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013596 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013597 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013598 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013599 presence of a flag).
13600
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013601bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13602 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13603 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013604 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013605
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013606concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13607 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13608 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13609 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13610 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13611 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13612 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13613 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13614 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13615 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13616 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13617 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13618 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13619 delimitors.
13620
13621 Example:
13622 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13623 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13624 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13625 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13626
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013627cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013628 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13629 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013630
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013631crc32([<avalanche>])
13632 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13633 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13634 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13635 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13636 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13637 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13638 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13639 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13640 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13641 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013642 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13643
13644crc32c([<avalanche>])
13645 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13646 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13647 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13648 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13649 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13650 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13651 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13652 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013653
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013654da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013655 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13656 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13657 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13658 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013659 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013660 configuration language.
13661
13662 Example:
13663 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013664 bind *:8881
13665 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013666 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013667
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013668debug
13669 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13670 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13671 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013673div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013674 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13675 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013676 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013677 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13678 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013679 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013680 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13681 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013686
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013687djb2([<avalanche>])
13688 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13689 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13690 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13691 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13692 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13693 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13694 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013695 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13696 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013697
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013698even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013699 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013700 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13701
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013702field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13703 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13704 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13705 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13706 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13707 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13708 fields.
13709
13710 Example :
13711 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13712 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13713 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13714 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13715 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013716
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013717hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013719 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013720 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013721 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013722
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013723hex2i
13724 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13725 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13726
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013727http_date([<offset>])
13728 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13729 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13730 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13731 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13732 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13733 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013735in_table(<table>)
13736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13738 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013739 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013740 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13741
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013742ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13743 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013744 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013745 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13746 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13747 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13748 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13749 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013750
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013751json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013753 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013754 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013755 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13756 of errors:
13757 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13758 bytes, ...)
13759 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13760 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13761
13762 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13763 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13764 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13765 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13766 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13767 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013768 - "ascii" : never fails;
13769 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13770 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013771 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013772 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013773 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13774 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13775
13776 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013778
13779 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013780 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013781 capture request header user-agent len 150
13782 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013783
13784 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13785 GET / HTTP/1.0
13786 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13787
13788 Output log:
13789 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13790
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013791language(<value>[,<default>])
13792 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13793 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13794 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13795 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13796 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13797 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13798 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13799 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13800 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013801 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013802 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13803 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013804
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013805 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013806
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013807 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13808 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013809
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013810 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13811 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13812 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13813 use_backend spanish if es
13814 use_backend french if fr
13815 use_backend english if en
13816 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013817
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013818length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013819 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13820 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13821 type. The result is of type integer.
13822
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013823lower
13824 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13825 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13826 type. The result is of type string.
13827
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013828ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13829 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13830 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13831 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13832 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13833 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13834 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13835
13836 Example :
13837
13838 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013839 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013840 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13841
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013842map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13843map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13844map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13845 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13846 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13847 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13848 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13849 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13850 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13851 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13852 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013854 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13855 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13856 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013857
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013858 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013859 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013861 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13862 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13863 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13864 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013865 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13866 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013867 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13868 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13869 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13870 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13871 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13872 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13873 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13874 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013875 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13876 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13877 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013878 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13879 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13880 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13881 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13882 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013883
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013884 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13885 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13886 the corresponding match text.
13887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013888 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13889 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13890 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13891 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13892 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013894 Example :
13895
13896 # this is a comment and is ignored
13897 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13898 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13899 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13900 | | | `---------- value
13901 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13902 | `---------------------------- key
13903 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13904
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013905mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013906 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13907 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013908 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013909 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013910 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013911 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13912 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13913 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13914 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013916 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013917
13918mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013919 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013920 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13921 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013922 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013923 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013924 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013925 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13926 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13927 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13928 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013930 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013931
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013932nbsrv
13933 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13934 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13935 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13936 map lookup.
13937
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013938neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013939 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13940 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13941 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13942 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013943
13944not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013945 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013946 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013947 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013948 absence of a flag).
13949
13950odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013951 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013952 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13953
13954or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013955 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013956 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013957 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13958 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013959 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013960 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13961 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13962 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13963 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013965 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013966
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013967protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13968 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13969 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13970 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13971 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13972 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13973 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13974 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13975 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13976 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13977 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13978 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13979
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013980regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013981 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13982 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13983 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13984 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13985 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13986 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13987 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13988 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13989 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13990 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013991 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13992 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13993 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13994 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013995
13996 Example :
13997
13998 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13999 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14000 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14001 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14002
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014003capture-req(<id>)
14004 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14005 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14006
14007 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014008 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14009 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014010
14011capture-res(<id>)
14012 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14013 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14014
14015 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014016 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14017 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014018
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014019sdbm([<avalanche>])
14020 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14021 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14022 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14023 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14024 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14025 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14026 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014027 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14028 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014029
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014030set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014031 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14032 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14033 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014034 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014035 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14036 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014037 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014038 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14039 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014040 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014041 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014042
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014043sha1
14044 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14045 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14046
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014047strcmp(<var>)
14048 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14049 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14050 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14051 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14052 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14053 shorter).
14054
14055 Example :
14056
14057 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14058 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14059 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14060
14061
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014062sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014063 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14064 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014065 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014066 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14067 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014068 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014069 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14070 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014071 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014072 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14073 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014074 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014075 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014076
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014077table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14081 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14082 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14083 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14084
14085
14086table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14090 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14091 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14092 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14093
14094table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014098 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14099 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14100
14101table_conn_cur(<table>)
14102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14105 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14106 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14107
14108table_conn_rate(<table>)
14109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14112 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14113 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14114
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014115table_gpt0(<table>)
14116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14119 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14120 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14121
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014122table_gpc0(<table>)
14123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14126 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14127 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14128
14129table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14133 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14134 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14135 sample fetch keyword.
14136
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014137table_gpc1(<table>)
14138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14140 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14141 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14142 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14143
14144table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14148 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14149 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14150 sample fetch keyword.
14151
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014152table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014156 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14157 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14158
14159table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14160 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14161 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14162 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14163 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14164 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14165 keyword.
14166
14167table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14168 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14169 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014170 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014171 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14172 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14173
14174table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14175 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14176 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14177 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14178 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14179 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14180 keyword.
14181
14182table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14183 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14184 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014185 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014186 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14187 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14188 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14189 keyword.
14190
14191table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14192 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14193 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014194 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014195 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14196 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14197 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14198 keyword.
14199
14200table_server_id(<table>)
14201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14203 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14204 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14205 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14206 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14207
14208table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014212 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14213 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14214 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14215 keyword.
14216
14217table_sess_rate(<table>)
14218 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14219 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14220 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14221 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14222 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14223 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14224 keyword.
14225
14226table_trackers(<table>)
14227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14229 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14230 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14231 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14232 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14233 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14234 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14235 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14236 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14237
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014238upper
14239 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14240 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14241 type. The result is of type string.
14242
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014243url_dec
14244 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14245 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14246
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014247ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014248 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014249 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14250 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14251 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014252 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14253 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14254 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14255 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014256 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014257 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14258 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014259
14260 Example:
14261 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14262 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14263
14264 message Point {
14265 int32 latitude = 1;
14266 int32 longitude = 2;
14267 }
14268
14269 message PPoint {
14270 Point point = 59;
14271 }
14272
14273 message Rectangle {
14274 // One corner of the rectangle.
14275 PPoint lo = 48;
14276 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14277 PPoint hi = 49;
14278 }
14279
14280 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14281 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14282 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14283
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014284 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14285 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14286 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14287 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14288
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014289 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014290
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014291 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014292
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014293 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14294 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14295 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14296
14297 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14298 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14299 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14300
14301 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14302 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14303 interpret the previous binary sample.
14304
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014305
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014306unset-var(<var name>)
14307 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14308 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14309 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14310 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14311 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14312 response),
14313 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14316 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14317
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014318utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14319 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14320 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14321 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14322 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14323 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14324 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14325
14326 Example :
14327
14328 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014329 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014330 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14331
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014332word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14333 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14334 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14335 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14336 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14337 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14338
14339 Example :
14340 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14341 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14342 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14343 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14344 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014345
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014346wt6([<avalanche>])
14347 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14348 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14349 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14350 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14351 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14352 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14353 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014354 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14355 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014356
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014357xor(<value>)
14358 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014359 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014360 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014361 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014362 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014363 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14364 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014365 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014366 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014369 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014370
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014371xxh32([<seed>])
14372 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14373 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14374 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14375 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14376 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14377 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14378 as cryptographically secure.
14379
14380xxh64([<seed>])
14381 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14382 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14383 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14384 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14385 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14386 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14387 as cryptographically secure.
14388
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143907.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391--------------------------------------------
14392
14393A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14394not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14395"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14396The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14397
14398always_false : boolean
14399 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14400 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14401
14402always_true : boolean
14403 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14404 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14405
14406avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014407 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14409 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14410 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14411 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14412 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14413 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14414 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14415 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14416 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14417 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14418 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14419 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14420 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014423 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14424 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14425 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14426 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014427 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14428
14429be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14431 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14432 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14433 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14434 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014435 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14436 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014437
14438 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14439 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14440 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14443 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14444 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14445 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014446 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14448 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014449
14450 Example :
14451 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14452 backend dynamic
14453 mode http
14454 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14455 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014456
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014458 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14459 of the string.
14460
14461bool(<bool>) : bool
14462 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14463 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014467 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14469 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014470
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014471 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014472 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014473 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14474
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014475 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14476 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014477
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014478 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014479 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014481 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014482 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014484 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014485
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014486 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14487 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014489 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014490
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014491cpu_calls : integer
14492 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14493 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14494 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14495 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14496 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14497 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14498
14499cpu_ns_avg : integer
14500 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14501 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14502 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14503 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14504 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14505 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14506 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14507 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14508 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14509 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14510 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14511
14512cpu_ns_tot : integer
14513 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14514 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14515 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14516 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14517 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14518 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14519 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14520 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14521 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14522 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14523 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14524 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14525 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14526
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014527date([<offset>]) : integer
14528 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14529 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14530 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14531 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014532 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14533
14534 Example :
14535
14536 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14537 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014538
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014539date_us : integer
14540 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14541 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14542 from the same timeval structure.
14543
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014544distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14545 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14546 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14547 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14548 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14549 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14550 list of supported tokens.
14551
14552distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14553 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14554 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14555 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14556 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14557 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14558 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14559 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14560 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14561 supported tokens.
14562
14563 Example :
14564 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14565 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14566 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14567 # send large files to the big farm
14568 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14569
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014570env(<name>) : string
14571 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14572 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14573 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14574 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14575 certain way.
14576
14577 Examples :
14578 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14579 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14580
14581 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14582 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14585 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014586 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14587 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014588 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14589 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014590 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14592 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014593
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014594fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14596 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14597 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14601 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14602 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14603 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14604 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14605 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14606 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14607 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014608
14609 Example :
14610 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14611 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14612 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14613 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14614 frontend mail
14615 bind :25
14616 mode tcp
14617 maxconn 100
14618 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14619 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14620 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14621 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014622
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014623hostname : string
14624 Returns the system hostname.
14625
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014626int(<integer>) : signed integer
14627 Returns a signed integer.
14628
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014629ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14630 Returns an ipv4.
14631
14632ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14633 Returns an ipv6.
14634
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014635lat_ns_avg : integer
14636 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14637 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14638 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14639 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14640 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14641 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14642 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14643 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14644 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14645 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14646 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14647 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14648 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14649 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14650
14651lat_ns_tot : integer
14652 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14653 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14654 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14655 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14656 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14657 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14658 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14659 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14660 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14661 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14662 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14663 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14664 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14665 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14666 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14667 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14668 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14669 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14670 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14671
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014672meth(<method>) : method
14673 Returns a method.
14674
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014675nbproc : integer
14676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14677 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14678 and debugging purposes.
14679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14682 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14683 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014684 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14685 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14686 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014687
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014688prio_class : integer
14689 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14690 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14691 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14692
14693prio_offset : integer
14694 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14695 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14696 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14697 set-priority-offset".
14698
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014699proc : integer
14700 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14701 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14702 debugging purposes.
14703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014705 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14706 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14707 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14709 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14710 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14711 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14712 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14713
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014714rand([<range>]) : integer
14715 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14716 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14717 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14718 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14719 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14723 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14724 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14725 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14726 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014727 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14728 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14729
14730srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14731 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14732 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14733 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14734 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14735 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14736 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14737 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14738
14739 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14740 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741
14742srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14743 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14744 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14745 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014746 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014747 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14748 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14749 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14750
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014751srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14752 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14753 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14754 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14755 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14756 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14757 fetch methods.
14758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14760 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14761 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014762 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14764 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014765 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766 overloading servers).
14767
14768 Example :
14769 # Redirect to a separate back
14770 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14771 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14772 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14773
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014774stopping : boolean
14775 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14776 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14777 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14778
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014779str(<string>) : string
14780 Returns a string.
14781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14783 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14784 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14785
14786table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14787 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14788 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14789 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14790
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014791thread : integer
14792 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14793 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14794 and debugging purposes.
14795
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014796var(<var-name>) : undefined
14797 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014798 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14799 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014803 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014804 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14805 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014806 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014807 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014808
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148097.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810----------------------------------
14811
14812The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14813closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14814methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14815sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14816TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014817the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14818counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014819"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14820used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14821can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14822Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14823table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14824tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14825currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014827bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014828 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14829 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14830 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832be_id : integer
14833 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14834 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14835
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014836be_name : string
14837 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14838 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840dst : ip
14841 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14842 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14843 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14844 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014845 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14846 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14847 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14848 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14849 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14850 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851
14852dst_conn : integer
14853 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14854 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14855 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14856 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14857 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14858 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14859 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14860 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014861
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014862dst_is_local : boolean
14863 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14864 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14865 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14866 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014867 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014868 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14869 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14870 it only once per connection.
14871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872dst_port : integer
14873 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14874 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14875 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14876 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14877 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14878 an HTTP header.
14879
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014880fc_http_major : integer
14881 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14882 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14883 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14884
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014885fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14886 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14887 header.
14888
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014889fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14890 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14891 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14892 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14893 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14894 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14895 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14896
14897fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14898 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14899 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14900 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14901 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14902 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14903 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14904
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014905fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14906 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14907 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14908 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14909 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14910
14911fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14912 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14913 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14914 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14915 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14916
14917fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14918 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14919 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14920 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14921 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14922
14923fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14924 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14925 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14926 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14927 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14928
14929fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14930 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14931 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14932 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14933 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14934
14935fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14936 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14937 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14938 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14939 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14940
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014941fe_defbe : string
14942 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14943 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945fe_id : integer
14946 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014947 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14949
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014950fe_name : string
14951 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14952 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14953 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14954
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014955sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014956sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14957sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14958sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014959 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14960 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14961 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14962
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014963sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014964sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14965sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14966sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014967 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14968 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14969 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14970
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014971sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014972sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14973sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14974sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014975 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14976 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014977 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14978 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14979 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014980
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014981 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014982 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14983 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014984 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14985 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14986 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014987 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14988 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14989
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014990sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14991sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14992sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14993sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14994 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14995 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14996 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14997 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14998 when a first ACL was verified.
14999
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015000sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015001sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15002sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15003sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015004 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015005 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015007sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015008sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15009sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15010sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015011 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15012 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15013 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015015sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015016sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15017sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15018sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015019 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15020 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15021 See also src_conn_rate.
15022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015023sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015024sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15025sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15026sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015027 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015028 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015029
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015030sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15031sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15032sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15033sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15034 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15035 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15036
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015037sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15038sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15039sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15040sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15041 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15042 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015044sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015045sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15046sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15047sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015048 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15049 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15050 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015051 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15052 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15053 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015054
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015055sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15056sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15057sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15058sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15059 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15060 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15061 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15062 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15063 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15064 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015066sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015067sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15068sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15069sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015070 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015071 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15072 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015074sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015075sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15076sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15077sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015078 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15079 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15080 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15081 src_http_err_rate.
15082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015083sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015084sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15085sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15086sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015087 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015088 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15089 src_http_req_cnt.
15090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015091sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015092sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15093sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15094sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015095 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15096 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15097 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15098 src_http_req_rate.
15099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015100sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015101sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15102sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15103sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015104 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015105 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15106 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15107 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15108 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015109
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015110 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015111 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15112 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015113 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15114
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015115sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15116sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15117sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15118sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15119 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15120 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15121 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15122 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15123 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15124
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015125sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015126sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15127sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15128sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015129 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15130 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15131 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015133sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015134sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15135sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15136sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015137 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15138 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15139 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015141sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015142sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15143sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15144sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015145 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015146 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15147 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15148 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015149 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015150 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15151
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015152sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015153sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15154sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15155sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015156 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15157 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15158 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15159 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15160 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015161 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015163sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015164sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15165sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15166sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015167 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15168 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15169 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15170
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015171sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015172sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15173sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15174sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015175 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15176 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015177 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015178 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15179 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15181 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15182 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184so_id : integer
15185 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15186 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15187 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015190 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15192 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15193 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015194 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15195 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15196 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015197 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15198 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15199 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15200 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15201 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15202 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15203 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015204
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015205 Example:
15206 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15207 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15210 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15211 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15212 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015213 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15216 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15217 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015218 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015219 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15222 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15223 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15224 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15225 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15226 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15227 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015228
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015229 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015230 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15231 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15232 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15233 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015234 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015235 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15236 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15237
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015238src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15239 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15240 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15241 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15242 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15243 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15244 was verified.
15245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015249 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015250 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015253 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15255 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015256 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15259 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15260 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15261 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015262 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015265 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015267 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015268 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015269
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015270src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15271 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15272 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15273 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15274 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15275
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015276src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15277 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15278 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15279 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15280 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015283 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015285 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15286 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015287 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15288 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15289 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015290
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015291src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15292 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15293 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15294 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15295 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15296 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15297 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15298 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015301 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015303 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015304 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15308 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15309 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15310 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15311 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015312 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15317 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015318 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15321 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15322 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15323 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015324 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015325 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15328 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15329 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15330 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015331 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15333 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015334
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015335 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015336 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015337 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015338 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015339
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015340src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15341 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15342 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15343 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15344 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15345 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15346 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15347
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015348src_is_local : boolean
15349 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15350 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15351 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15352 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015354 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15355 once per connection.
15356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015358 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15359 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15360 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15361 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15362 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015365 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15366 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15367 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15368 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15369 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371src_port : integer
15372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15373 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15374 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15375 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015378 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015379 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15380 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15381 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015382 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15385 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15386 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15387 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15388 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015389 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15392 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15393 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15394 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15395 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15396 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15397 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15398 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15399 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015400
15401 Example :
15402 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15403 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15404 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15405 listen ssh
15406 bind :22
15407 mode tcp
15408 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015409 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015410 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015411 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413srv_id : integer
15414 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15415 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15416 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015417
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154187.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15422closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15423when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15424usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015425future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015426
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001542751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15428 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15429 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15430 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15431 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15432 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15433
15434 Example :
15435 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15436 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15437 # the request.
15438 frontend http-in
15439 bind *:8081
15440 default_backend servers
15441 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15442 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15443
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015444ssl_bc : boolean
15445 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15446 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15447 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15448
15449ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15450 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15451 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15452
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015453ssl_bc_alpn : string
15454 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15455 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015456 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015457 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15458 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15459 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15460 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15461 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15462 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15463
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015464ssl_bc_cipher : string
15465 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15466 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15467
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015468ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15469 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15470 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15471 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15472
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015473ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15474 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15475 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15476 session or a TLS ticket.
15477
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015478ssl_bc_npn : string
15479 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15480 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015481 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015482 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15483 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15484 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15485 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15486 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15487
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015488ssl_bc_protocol : string
15489 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15490 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15491
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015492ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015493 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015494 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15495 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015496
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015497ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15498 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15499 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15500 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15501
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015502ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15503 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15504 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15505 if session was reused or not.
15506
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015507ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15508 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15509 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15510 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15511 BoringSSL.
15512
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015513ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15514 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15515 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15518 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15519 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15520 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15521 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15522 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15525 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15526 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15527 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15528 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015529
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015530ssl_c_der : binary
15531 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15532 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15533 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535ssl_c_err : integer
15536 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15537 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15538 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15539 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15540 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15543 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15544 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15545 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15546 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15547 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15548 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15549 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15550 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552ssl_c_key_alg : string
15553 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15554 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15555 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557ssl_c_notafter : string
15558 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15559 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15560 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562ssl_c_notbefore : string
15563 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15564 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15565 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15568 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15569 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15570 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15571 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15572 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15573 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15574 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15575 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577ssl_c_serial : binary
15578 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15579 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15580 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15583 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15584 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15585 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015586 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15587 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15588
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015589 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015590 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15593 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15594 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15595 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597ssl_c_used : boolean
15598 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15599 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601ssl_c_verify : integer
15602 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15603 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15604 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15605 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607ssl_c_version : integer
15608 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15609 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015610
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015611ssl_f_der : binary
15612 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15613 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15614 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15617 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15618 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15619 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15620 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015621 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15623 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15624 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626ssl_f_key_alg : string
15627 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15628 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15629 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631ssl_f_notafter : string
15632 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15633 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15634 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636ssl_f_notbefore : string
15637 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15638 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15639 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15642 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15643 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15644 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15645 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15646 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15647 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15648 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15649 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651ssl_f_serial : binary
15652 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15653 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15654 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015655
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015656ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15657 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15658 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15659 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15662 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15663 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15664 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666ssl_f_version : integer
15667 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15668 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15669
15670ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015671 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15672 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15673 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675 Example :
15676 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15677 listen http-https
15678 bind :80
15679 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15680 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15681
15682ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15683 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15684 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15685
15686ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015687 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15689 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15690 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15691 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15692 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15693 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15694 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15695 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697ssl_fc_cipher : string
15698 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15699 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015700
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015701ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15702 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15703 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015704 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015705
15706ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15707 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15708 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015709 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015710
15711ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15712 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15713 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15714 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015715 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015716 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015717
15718ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15719 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15720 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015721 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015722
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015723ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15724 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15725 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15726 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015729 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15730 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015731 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15732 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15733 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15734 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015735
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015736ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15737 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15738 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15739 wait until the handshake happened.
15740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15742 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015743 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15744 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15745 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15746 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015747
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015748ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015749 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015750 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15751 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015754 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15756 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15757 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15758 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15759 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15760 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15761 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763ssl_fc_protocol : string
15764 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15765 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015766
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015767ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015768 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015769 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15770 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015771
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015772ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15773 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15774 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15775 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15778 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15779 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15780 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15781 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015782
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015783ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15784 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15785 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15786 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15787 BoringSSL.
15788
15789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790ssl_fc_sni : string
15791 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15792 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15793 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15794 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15795 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15796
15797 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15798 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15799 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015800 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15801 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15805 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15808 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15809 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015810
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158127.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15816sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15817only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15818For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15819be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15820can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15821sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15822for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15823content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015826 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15828 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15831 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015832 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015834
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015835req.hdrs : string
15836 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15837 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15838 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15839 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15840
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015841req.hdrs_bin : binary
15842 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15843 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15844 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15845 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15846 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15847 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15848
15849 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15850
15851 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15852 str: <int:length><bytes>
15853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854req.len : integer
15855req_len : integer (deprecated)
15856 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15857 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15858 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15859 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15860 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15861 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15862 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15863 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15866 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015867 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15868 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15869 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15870 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872 ACL alternatives :
15873 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15876 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15877 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15878 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15879 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 ACL alternatives :
15882 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886req.proto_http : boolean
15887req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15888 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15889 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15890 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15891 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15892 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15893 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15894 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896 Example:
15897 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15898 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15899 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015900 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15903rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15904 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15905 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15906 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15907 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15908 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15909 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15910 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15913 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15914 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15915 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15916 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15917 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919 ACL derivatives :
15920 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 Example :
15923 listen tse-farm
15924 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15925 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15926 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15927 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15928 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15929 persist rdp-cookie
15930 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15931 # This is only useful makes sense if
15932 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15933 stick-table type string size 204800
15934 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15935 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15936 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15939 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15942rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15943 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15944 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15945 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15946 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 ACL derivatives :
15949 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015950
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015951req.ssl_alpn : string
15952 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15953 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15954 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15955 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15956 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15957 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015958 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015959
15960 Examples :
15961 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15962 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15963 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015964 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015965 default_backend bk_default
15966
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015967req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15968 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15969 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015970 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15971 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15972 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15973 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15974 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15977req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15978 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15979 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15980 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15981 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15982 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15983 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15984 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986req.ssl_sni : string
15987req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15988 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15989 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15990 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15991 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15992 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15993 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15994 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15995 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15996 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15997 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15998 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15999 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001 ACL derivatives :
16002 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004 Examples :
16005 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16006 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16007 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16008 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16009 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016010
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016011req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16012 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16013 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16014 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16015 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16016 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16017 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16018 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16019 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16020 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022req.ssl_ver : integer
16023req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16024 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16025 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16026 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16027 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16028 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16029 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16030 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016031 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 ACL derivatives :
16035 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016036
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016037res.len : integer
16038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16039 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16040 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16041 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16042 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16043 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16044 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16045 content inspection.
16046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16048 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016049 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16050 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16051 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16052 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16055 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16056 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16057 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16058 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016061
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016062res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16063rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16064 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16065 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16066 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16067 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16068 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16069 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16070 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072wait_end : boolean
16073 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16074 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016075 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16077 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016078 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16080 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082 Examples :
16083 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16084 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16085 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16088 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16089 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16090 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16091 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16092 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16093 tcp-request content reject
16094
16095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160967.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097--------------------------------------
16098
16099It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16100This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16101data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16102its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16103HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16104content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16105to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16106more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16107response are indexed.
16108
16109base : string
16110 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16111 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16112 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16113 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16114 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16115 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16116 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16117 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16118
16119 ACL derivatives :
16120 base : exact string match
16121 base_beg : prefix match
16122 base_dir : subdir match
16123 base_dom : domain match
16124 base_end : suffix match
16125 base_len : length match
16126 base_reg : regex match
16127 base_sub : substring match
16128
16129base32 : integer
16130 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16131 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16132 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016133 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16134 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16135 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136
16137base32+src : binary
16138 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16139 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16140 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16141 per-URL counters.
16142
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016143capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16144 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16145 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16146 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16147
16148capture.req.method : string
16149 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16150 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16151 because it's allocated.
16152
16153capture.req.uri : string
16154 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16155 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16156 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16157 allocated.
16158
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016159capture.req.ver : string
16160 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16161 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16162 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16163
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016164capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16165 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16166 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16167 The first entry is an index of 0.
16168 See also: "capture response header"
16169
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016170capture.res.ver : string
16171 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16172 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16173 persistent flag.
16174
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016175req.body : binary
16176 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16177 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16178 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16179 the first chunk is analyzed.
16180
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016181req.body_param([<name>) : string
16182 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16183 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16184 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16185 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16186 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16187 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16188 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16189 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16190 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16191 given.
16192
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016193req.body_len : integer
16194 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16195 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16196 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16197 "option http-buffer-request".
16198
16199req.body_size : integer
16200 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16201 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16202 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16203 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16204 "option http-buffer-request".
16205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206req.cook([<name>]) : string
16207cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16208 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16209 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16210 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16211 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16212 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16213 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16214 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16215 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16216
16217 ACL derivatives :
16218 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16219 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16220 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16221 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16222 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16223 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16224 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16225 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16228cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16229 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16230 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16233cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16234 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16235 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16236 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16237 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16240 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16241 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16242 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16243 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016244 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16246 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16247 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16248 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16251 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16252 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16253 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16254 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016255 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16258 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16259 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16260 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16261 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16262 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16263 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16264 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16265 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16268 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16269 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16270 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16271 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16274 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16275 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16276 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16277 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16278 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16279 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16280 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16281 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016282 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 ACL derivatives :
16287 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16288 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16289 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16290 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16291 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16292 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16293 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16294 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16295
16296req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16297hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16298 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16299 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16300 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16301 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16302 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16303 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16304 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16305 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16306 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16307
16308req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16309hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16310 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16311 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16312 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16313 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16314 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016315 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16317 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16318
16319req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16320hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16321 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16322 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16323 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16324 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16325 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16326 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16327 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16328
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016329
16330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16332 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16333 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16334 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16335 basic auth is supported.
16336
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016337http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16338 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16339 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16340 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16341 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16343 basic auth is supported.
16344
16345 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016346 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16347 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16348 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16349 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350
16351http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016352 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16353 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16355 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357method : integer + string
16358 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16359 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16360 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16361 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16362 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16363 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16364 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366 ACL derivatives :
16367 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369 Example :
16370 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16371 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16372 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374path : string
16375 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16376 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16377 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16378 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16379 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016380 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383 ACL derivatives :
16384 path : exact string match
16385 path_beg : prefix match
16386 path_dir : subdir match
16387 path_dom : domain match
16388 path_end : suffix match
16389 path_len : length match
16390 path_reg : regex match
16391 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016392
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016393query : string
16394 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16395 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16396 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16397 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016398 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016399 which stops before the question mark.
16400
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016401req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16402 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16403 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16404 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16405 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016407req.ver : string
16408req_ver : string (deprecated)
16409 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16410 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16411 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413 ACL derivatives :
16414 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016416res.comp : boolean
16417 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16418 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16419 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421res.comp_algo : string
16422 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16423 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16424 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016426res.cook([<name>]) : string
16427scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16428 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16429 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16430 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432 ACL derivatives :
16433 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16436scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16437 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16438 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16439 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16442scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16443 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16444 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16445 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16448 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16449 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16450 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16451 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16452 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16453 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16454 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16455 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16456 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016458res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16459 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16460 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16461 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16462 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16463 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016465res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16466shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16468 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16469 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16470 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16471 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16472 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16473 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16474 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016476 ACL derivatives :
16477 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16478 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16479 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16480 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16481 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16482 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16483 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16484 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16485
16486res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16487shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16488 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16489 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16490 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16491 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16492 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16495shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16496 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16497 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16498 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16499 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16500 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16501 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016502
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016503res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16504 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16505 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16506 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16507 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16510shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16511 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16512 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16513 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16514 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16515 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16516 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518res.ver : string
16519resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16520 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16521 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523 ACL derivatives :
16524 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16527 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16528 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016529 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016532 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16533 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535status : integer
16536 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16537 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16538 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016539
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016540unique-id : string
16541 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16542 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16543 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16544 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16545 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16546 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548url : string
16549 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16550 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16551 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16552 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16553 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16554 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16555 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 ACL derivatives :
16558 url : exact string match
16559 url_beg : prefix match
16560 url_dir : subdir match
16561 url_dom : domain match
16562 url_end : suffix match
16563 url_len : length match
16564 url_reg : regex match
16565 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016567url_ip : ip
16568 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16569 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16570 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16571 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16572 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16573 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16574 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576url_port : integer
16577 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16578 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16579 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16580 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016581
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016582urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16583url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16585 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016586 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16587 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16588 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16589 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16591 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016592 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16593 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595 ACL derivatives :
16596 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16597 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16598 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16599 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16600 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16601 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16602 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16603 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016604
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 Example :
16607 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16608 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16609 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16610 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016611
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016612urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016613 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16614 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16615 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016616
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016617url32 : integer
16618 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16619 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16620 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16621 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16622 is an unsigned integer.
16623
16624url32+src : binary
16625 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16626 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16627 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16628
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166307.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016631---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016633Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16634every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016635order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016637ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16638---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016639FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016640HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016641HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16642HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016643HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16644HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16645HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16646HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16647LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016648METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016649METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016650METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16651METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16652METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16653METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016654METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016655METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016656RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016657REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016658TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016659WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16660---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166638. Logging
16664----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016665
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16667provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16668very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16669provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16670state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016671to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016672headers.
16673
16674In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16675about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16676send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16677
16678 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16679 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16680 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16681 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16682 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016684 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016685
16686The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16687allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16688as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16689while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16690real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16691delay.
16692
16693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166948.1. Log levels
16695---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016697TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016699HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16700in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16701track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16702syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16703about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704
16705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167068.2. Log formats
16707----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016708
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016709HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016710and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16711slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16712options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
16714 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16715 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16716 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16717 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16718 extents.
16719
16720 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16721 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16722 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16723 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16724 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16725
16726 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16727 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16728 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16729 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16730 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16731
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016732 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16733 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16734 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16735 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16736
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016737 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16740specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16741field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16742servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16743always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16744identifier.
16745
16746Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16747 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16748 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16749 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16750 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16751
16752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167538.2.1. Default log format
16754-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016755
16756This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16757as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16758format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16759
16760 Example :
16761 listen www
16762 mode http
16763 log global
16764 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16765
16766 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16767 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16768 (www/HTTP)
16769
16770 Field Format Extract from the example above
16771 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16772 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16773 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16774 4 'to' to
16775 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16776 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16777
16778Detailed fields description :
16779 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16780 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16781 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16782 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16783 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16784 and processed the connection.
16785 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16786
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016787In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16788"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16789connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16790
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016791It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16792will eventually disappear.
16793
16794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167958.2.2. TCP log format
16796---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016797
16798The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16799is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16800information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16801counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16802emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16803environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16804the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16805sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016806specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16807not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16808fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16809marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016810
16811 Example :
16812 frontend fnt
16813 mode tcp
16814 option tcplog
16815 log global
16816 default_backend bck
16817
16818 backend bck
16819 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16820
16821 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16822 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16823 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16824
16825 Field Format Extract from the example above
16826 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16827 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16828 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16829 4 frontend_name fnt
16830 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16831 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16832 7 bytes_read* 212
16833 8 termination_state --
16834 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16835 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16836
16837Detailed fields description :
16838 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016839 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16840 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16841 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016842 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016843 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016844 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016845
16846 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016847 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16848 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16849 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016850
16851 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16852 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16853 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016854 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16855 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16856 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16857 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858
16859 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16860 and processed the connection.
16861
16862 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16863 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16864 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16865 applications.
16866
16867 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16868 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16869 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16870 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16871 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16872
16873 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16874 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16875 See "Timers" below for more details.
16876
16877 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16878 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16879 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16880 "Timers" below for more details.
16881
16882 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016883 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016884 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16885 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16886 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16887 details.
16888
16889 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16890 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16891 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16892 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16893 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16894
16895 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16896 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16897 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16898 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16899 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16900 for more details.
16901
16902 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016903 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016904 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16905 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16906 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016907 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016908
16909 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16910 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16911 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16912 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16913 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16914 caused by a denial of service attack.
16915
16916 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16917 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16918 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16919 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16920 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16921 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16922 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16923 denial of service attack.
16924
16925 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16926 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16927 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16928 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16929 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16930 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16931 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16932 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16933 be processed than on other servers.
16934
16935 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16936 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16937 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16938 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16939 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16940 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16941 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16942 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16943 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16944 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16945 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16946 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16947 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16948
16949 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16950 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16951 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16952 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16953 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16954 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016955 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16957
16958 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16959 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16960 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16961 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16962 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16963 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016964 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016965 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16966 occurs.
16967
16968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169698.2.3. HTTP log format
16970----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971
16972The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16973is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16974the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16975are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16976emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16977generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16978"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16979which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016980frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16981is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016982
16983Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16984slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16985with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16986
16987 Example :
16988 frontend http-in
16989 mode http
16990 option httplog
16991 log global
16992 default_backend bck
16993
16994 backend static
16995 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16996
16997 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16998 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16999 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017000 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017001
17002 Field Format Extract from the example above
17003 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17004 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017005 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006 4 frontend_name http-in
17007 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017008 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009 7 status_code 200
17010 8 bytes_read* 2750
17011 9 captured_request_cookie -
17012 10 captured_response_cookie -
17013 11 termination_state ----
17014 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17015 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17016 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17017 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17018 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020Detailed fields description :
17021 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017022 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17023 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17024 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017025 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017026 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017027 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017030 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17031 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17032 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017034 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17035 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017036
17037 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17038 and processed the connection.
17039
17040 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17041 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17042 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17043
17044 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17045 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17046 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17047 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17048 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17049 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17050
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017051 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17052 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17053 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
17054 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
17055 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17056 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017057 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17058 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017059
17060 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17061 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017062 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063
17064 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17065 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017066 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17067 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068
17069 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17070 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17071 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17072 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17073 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017074 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17075 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017076
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017077 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17078 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17079 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17080 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17081 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17082 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17083 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017084 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017085
17086 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17087 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17088 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17089
17090 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17091 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17092 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17093 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17094 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17095 overflowing.
17096
17097 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17098 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17099 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17100 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17101 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17102 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17103 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17104 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17105
17106 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17107 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17108 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17109 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17110 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17111 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17112 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17113 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17114
17115 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17116 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17117 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17118 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17119 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17120 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17121 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17122
17123 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017124 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017125 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17126 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17127 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017128 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017129 system.
17130
17131 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17132 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17133 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17134 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17135 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17136 caused by a denial of service attack.
17137
17138 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17139 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17140 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17141 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17142 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17143 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17144 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17145 denial of service attack.
17146
17147 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17148 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17149 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17150 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17151 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17152 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17153 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17154 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17155 processed than on other servers.
17156
17157 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17158 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17159 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17160 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17161 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17162 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17163 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17164 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17165 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17166 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17167 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17168 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17169 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17170
17171 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17172 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17173 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17174 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17175 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17176 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017177 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17179
17180 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17181 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17182 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17183 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17184 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17185 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017186 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017187 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17188 occurs.
17189
17190 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17191 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17192 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17193 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17194 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17195 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17196 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17197 cookies" below for more details.
17198
17199 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17200 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17201 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17202 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17203 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17204 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17205 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17206 and cookies" below for more details.
17207
17208 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17209 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17210 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17211 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17212 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17213 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17214 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17215 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17216
17217
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172188.2.4. Custom log format
17219------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017220
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017221The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017222mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017223
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017224HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017225Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17226separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17227prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17228
17229Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17230variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017231("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017232
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017233If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017234as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017235less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17236the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17237
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017238Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017239In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017240in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017241
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017242Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17243'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17244https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17245such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17246
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017247Flags are :
17248 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017249 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017250 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17251 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017252
17253 Example:
17254
17255 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17256 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17257
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017258 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17259
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017260At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17261
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017262 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17263 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017264
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017265the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017266
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017267 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17268 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17269 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017270
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017271and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017273 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17274 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017275
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017276Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17277
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017278 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017279 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017280 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17281 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17282 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017283 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17284 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17285 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017286 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017287 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17288 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017289 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017290 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17291 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017292 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017293 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017294 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017295 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017296 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017297 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017298 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017299 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17300 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17301 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17302 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17303 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017304 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017305 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17306 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017307 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017308 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17309 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017310 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17311 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17312 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017313 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017314 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17315 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017316 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017317 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17318 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17319 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017320 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017321 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017322 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17323 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17324 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17325 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017326 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017327 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017328 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017329 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017330 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017331 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017332 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17333 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17334 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017335 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017336 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17337 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017338 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017339 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17340 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017341 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017342 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017343 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017344 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017345
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017346 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017347
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017348
173498.2.5. Error log format
17350-----------------------
17351
17352When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17353protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17354By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17355"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017356will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017357logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17358
17359The format looks like this :
17360
17361 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17362 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17363 Connection error during SSL handshake
17364
17365 Field Format Extract from the example above
17366 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17367 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17368 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17369 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17370 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17371
17372These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17373failures.
17374
17375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173768.3. Advanced logging options
17377-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017378
17379Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17380just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17381options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17382for more information about their usage.
17383
17384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173858.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17386------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017387
17388It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17389haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17390commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17391monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17392ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17393
17394 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17395 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17396 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17397 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17398
17399 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17400 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17401 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017402 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403 such as other load-balancers.
17404
17405 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17406 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17407 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17408
17409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174108.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17411----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017412
17413The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17414what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17415or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017416"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17418log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17419after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17420is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17421with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17422with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17423
17424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174258.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17426------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017427
17428Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17429for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17430"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17431retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17432raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17433a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17434file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17435you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17436"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17437
17438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174398.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17440--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017441
17442Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17443multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17444them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17445"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17446logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17447error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17448and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17449too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17450useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17451alternative.
17452
17453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174548.4. Timing events
17455------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017456
17457Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17458reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17459the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17460frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017461mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17462addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17463
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017464Timings events in HTTP mode:
17465
17466 first request 2nd request
17467 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17468 t tr t tr ...
17469 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17470 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17471 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17472 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17473 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17474
17475Timings events in TCP mode:
17476
17477 TCP session
17478 |<----------------->|
17479 t t
17480 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17481 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17482 |<------ Tt ------->|
17483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017484 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017485 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017486 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17487 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17488 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017489 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017490 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17491 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17492 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17493 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017494
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017495 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17496 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17497 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017498 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17499 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17500 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17501 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17502 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17503 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017504
17505 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17506 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17507 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17508 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17509 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17510 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17511 request typed by hand during a test.
17512
17513 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17514 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017515 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017516 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17517 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17518 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17519 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017520
17521 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17522 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17523 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17524 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17525 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17526
17527 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17528 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17529 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17530 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17531 connection never established.
17532
17533 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17534 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17535 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17536 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17537 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17538 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17539 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17540 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17541 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17542 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17543 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017545 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17546 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17547 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17548 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17549 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17550 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17551
17552 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17553
17554 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17555 "Ta" can never be negative.
17556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017557 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17558 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017559 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17560 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017561 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017563 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564
17565 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017566 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17567 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017568
17569These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17570protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17571that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017572due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17573"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17574that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017575
17576Most common cases :
17577
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017578 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17579 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17580 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17581 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17582 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17583 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17584 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17585 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17586 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17587 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17588 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017589 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017590
17591 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17592 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17593 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17594 of ms on remote networks.
17595
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017596 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17597 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17598 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017599
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017600 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17601 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17602 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17603 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17604 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17605 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17606 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17607 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17608 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017609
17610Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17611
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017612 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017613 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017614 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017616 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017617 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17618 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017620 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017621 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17622 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17623 flags.
17624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017625 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17626 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017627 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17628 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17629 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17630 the client connection was maintained open.
17631
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017632 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017633 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017634 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017635 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17636
17637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176388.5. Session state at disconnection
17639-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017640
17641TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17642"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176432-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17644each of which has a special meaning :
17645
17646 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17647 session to terminate :
17648
17649 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17650
17651 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17652 server explicitly refused it.
17653
17654 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17655 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17656 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17657 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017658 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017659
17660 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17661 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662
17663 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17664 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17665 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17666 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17667 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17668
17669 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17670 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17671 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17672 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17673 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17674
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017675 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17676 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17677
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017678 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17679 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17680 backup connections when going up.
17681
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017682 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017684 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17685 send or receive data.
17686
17687 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17688 send or receive data.
17689
17690 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17691 with nothing left in the buffers.
17692
17693 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17694
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017695 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17697
17698 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17699 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17700 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17701 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17702 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17703
17704 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17705 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17706
17707 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17708 server (HTTP only).
17709
17710 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17711
17712 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17713 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17714 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17715
17716 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17717 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17718 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17719
17720 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17721
17722 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17723 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17724
17725 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17726 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17727 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17728
17729 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17730 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017731 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17732 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017733
17734 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17735 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17736 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17737 another server.
17738
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017739 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017740 server.
17741
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017742 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17743 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17744 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17745 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17746
17747 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17748 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17749 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17750 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17751
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017752 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17753 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17754 "use-server" rule).
17755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017756 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17757
17758 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17759 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17760
17761 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17762
17763 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17764 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17765 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17766
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017767 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17768 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017769 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017770 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17771 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17772
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017773 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17774
17775 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17776 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17777
17778 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17779
17780 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17781
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017782The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17783was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017784helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17785starvation, attacks, etc...
17786
17787The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17788alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17789easier finding and understanding.
17790
17791 Flags Reason
17792
17793 -- Normal termination.
17794
17795 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17796 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17797 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17798 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17799
17800 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17801 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17802 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17803 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17804 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17805 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17808 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017809 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810
17811 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17812 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17813 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17814
17815 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17816 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17817 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17818 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17819 the server takes too long to respond.
17820
17821 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17822 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17823 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17824 long a time to respond.
17825
17826 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17827 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17828 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17829 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017830 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17831 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832
17833 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17834 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17835 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17836 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17837 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017838 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017839 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17840 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17841 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17842 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17843 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17844 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17845 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17846 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017847 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017848 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17849 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17850 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017851
17852 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17853 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017854 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17855 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17856 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17857 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017859 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17860 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017862 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17864 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017865 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017866 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17867 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17868
17869 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17870 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17871 503 or 504 here.
17872
17873 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17874 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17875 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17876 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17877 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17878
17879 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17880 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017881 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017882 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17883 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17884
17885 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17886 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17887 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17888 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17889 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17890 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17891 between haproxy and the server.
17892
17893 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17894 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17895 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17896 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17897 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17898 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17899 solution is to fix the application.
17900
17901 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17902 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17903 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17904 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17905 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17906 external attacks.
17907
17908 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17909 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017910 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17912 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17913
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017914 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17915 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17916 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017917 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017918 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017920 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17921 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17922 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17923 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017924 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17925 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17926 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17927 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17928 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017929
17930 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17931 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17932 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17933 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17934
17935 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17936 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17937 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17938 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17939
17940 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17941 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17942 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17943 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17944
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017945The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17946persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17947important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17948re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17949
17950 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17951
17952 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17953 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17954 set on a GET request.
17955
17956 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17957 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017958 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017959 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17960
17961 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17962 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17963 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17964
17965 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17966 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17967 already got a cookie.
17968
17969 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17970 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17971 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17972 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17973 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17974
17975 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17976 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17977 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17978
17979 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17980 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17981 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17982
17983 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17984 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17985
17986 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17987 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17988 then advertised in the response.
17989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179918.6. Non-printable characters
17992-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017993
17994In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17995consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17996converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17997prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17998being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17999escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18000is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18001'}' when logging headers.
18002
18003Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18004issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18005containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18006
18007Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18008the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18009performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18010
18011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18013---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018014
18015Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18016achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018017section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018018cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18019the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18020the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018021locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018022not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18023user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18024a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18025wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18026
18027 Examples :
18028 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18029 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18030
18031 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18032 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18033
18034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180358.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18036---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018037
18038Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18039proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18040the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18041server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18042
18043Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18044response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018045section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018046
18047It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018048time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18049appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018050are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18051and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18052follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18053request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18054in the logs.
18055
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018056As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18057frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18058an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018060 Example :
18061 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18062 listen proxy-out
18063 mode http
18064 option httplog
18065 option logasap
18066 log global
18067 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18068
18069 # log the name of the virtual server
18070 capture request header Host len 20
18071
18072 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18073 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18074
18075 # log the beginning of the referrer
18076 capture request header Referer len 20
18077
18078 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18079 capture response header Server len 20
18080
18081 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18082 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18083
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018084 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18086
18087 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18088 capture response header Via len 20
18089
18090 # log the URL location during a redirection
18091 capture response header Location len 20
18092
18093 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18094 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18095 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18096 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18097 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18098
18099 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18100 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18101 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18102 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018103 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018104
18105 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18108 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18109 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018110 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018111
18112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181138.9. Examples of logs
18114---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018115
18116These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18117them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18118reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18119
18120 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18121 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18122 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18123
18124 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18125 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18126
18127 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18128 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18129 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18130
18131 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18132 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18133
18134 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18135 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18136 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18137
18138 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018139 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018140 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18141 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18142
18143 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18144 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18145 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18146
18147 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18148 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018149 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018150 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18151 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18152 to return the 502 and not the server.
18153
18154 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018155 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018156
18157 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18158 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18159 Nothing was sent to any server.
18160
18161 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18162 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18163
18164 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18165 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018166 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018167 send a 408 return code to the client.
18168
18169 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18170 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18171
18172 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18173 5 seconds ("c----").
18174
18175 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18176 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018177 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018178
18179 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018180 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018181 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18182 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18183 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18184 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18185 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018186
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181889. Supported filters
18189--------------------
18190
18191Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18192accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18193unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18194
18195See also : "filter"
18196
181979.1. Trace
18198----------
18199
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018200filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018201
18202 Arguments:
18203 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18204 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18205
18206 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18207 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18208 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18209 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018211 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018212 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18213 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18214 amount of the parsed data.
18215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018216 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018217
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018218This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18219callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18220information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18221filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18222
18223Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18224tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18225a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18226
18227
182289.2. HTTP compression
18229---------------------
18230
18231filter compression
18232
18233The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18234keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018235when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18236it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18237response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18238line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18239cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18240the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018241
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018242See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018243
18244
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182459.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18246--------------------------------------------
18247
18248filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18249
18250 Arguments :
18251
18252 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18253 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18254 parsed.
18255
18256 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18257 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18258 part must be placed in its own scope.
18259
18260The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18261external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018262streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018263exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18264also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18265
18266SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18267the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18268
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018269For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018270"doc/SPOE.txt".
18271
18272Important note:
18273 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18274 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18275
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182769.4. Cache
18277----------
18278
18279filter cache <name>
18280
18281 Arguments :
18282
18283 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18284
18285The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18286"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18287cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018288other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18289the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18290mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18291filter other than the compression is used for the same
18292listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18293order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018294
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018295See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018296
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001829710. Cache
18298---------
18299
18300HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18301(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18302RAM.
18303
18304The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018305this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018306
18307If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18308independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18309when we try to allocate a new one.
18310
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018311The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018312
18313It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18314"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18315for more details.
18316
18317When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18318replaced by "<CACHE>".
18319
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001832010.1. Limitation
18321----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018322
18323The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18324
18325- If the response is not a 200
18326- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018327- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018328- If the response is not cacheable
18329
18330- If the request is not a GET
18331- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018332- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018333
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018334Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18335filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18336can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18337example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18338"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018339
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001834010.2. Setup
18341-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018342
18343To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18344the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18345
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001834610.2.1. Cache section
18347---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018348
18349cache <name>
18350 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18351 size of cache is mandatory.
18352
18353total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018354 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018355 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018356
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018357max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018358 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18359 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18360 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018361
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018362max-age <seconds>
18363 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18364 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18365 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18366 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18367 default.
18368
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001836910.2.2. Proxy section
18370---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018371
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018372http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018373 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18374 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18375 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18376 after this one.
18377
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018378http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018379 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18380 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18381 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18382 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18383
18384
18385Example:
18386
18387 backend bck1
18388 mode http
18389
18390 http-request cache-use foobar
18391 http-response cache-store foobar
18392 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18393
18394 cache foobar
18395 total-max-size 4
18396 max-age 240
18397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018398/*
18399 * Local variables:
18400 * fill-column: 79
18401 * End:
18402 */